Mercurial > emacs
annotate src/gtkutil.c @ 112453:06719a229a46 default tip
* calc/calc.el (calc-default-power-reference-level)
(calc-default-field-reference-level): New variables.
* calc/calc-units.el (math-standard-units): Add dB and Np.
(math-logunits): New variable.
(math-extract-logunits, math-logcombine, calcFunc-luplus)
(calcFunc-luminus, calc-luplus, calc-luminus, math-logunit-level)
(calcFunc-fieldlevel, calcFunc-powerlevel, calc-level): New
functions.
(math-find-base-units-rec): Add entry for ln(10).
* calc/calc-help.el (calc-u-prefix-help): Add logarithmic help.
(calc-ul-prefix-help): New function.
* calc/calc-ext.el (calc-init-extensions): Autoload new units
functions. Add keybindings for new units functions.
author | Jay Belanger <jay.p.belanger@gmail.com> |
---|---|
date | Sun, 23 Jan 2011 23:08:04 -0600 |
parents | 9de5a68b57e1 |
children |
rev | line source |
---|---|
49323 | 1 /* Functions for creating and updating GTK widgets. |
112218
376148b31b5e
Add 2011 to FSF/AIST copyright years.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
111746
diff
changeset
|
2 Copyright (C) 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011 |
79759 | 3 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
49323 | 4 |
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs. | |
6 | |
94963
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
93427
diff
changeset
|
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify |
49323 | 8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by |
94963
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
93427
diff
changeset
|
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or |
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
93427
diff
changeset
|
10 (at your option) any later version. |
49323 | 11 |
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, | |
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of | |
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the | |
15 GNU General Public License for more details. | |
16 | |
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License | |
94963
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
93427
diff
changeset
|
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */ |
49323 | 19 |
80608
83a48972e1ea
Include <config.h> instead of "config.h".
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
79759
diff
changeset
|
20 #include <config.h> |
49323 | 21 |
22 #ifdef USE_GTK | |
58818
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
23 #include <signal.h> |
49359
14cf50ecf91a
gtkutil.c: Must include stdio.h before termhooks.h
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49325
diff
changeset
|
24 #include <stdio.h> |
105669
68dd71358159
* alloc.c: Do not define struct catchtag.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
105522
diff
changeset
|
25 #include <setjmp.h> |
49323 | 26 #include "lisp.h" |
27 #include "xterm.h" | |
28 #include "blockinput.h" | |
58818
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
29 #include "syssignal.h" |
49323 | 30 #include "window.h" |
31 #include "gtkutil.h" | |
32 #include "termhooks.h" | |
51408
8f1bed1dee3c
Include keyboard.h, charset.h, coding.h.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
51211
diff
changeset
|
33 #include "keyboard.h" |
8f1bed1dee3c
Include keyboard.h, charset.h, coding.h.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
51211
diff
changeset
|
34 #include "charset.h" |
8f1bed1dee3c
Include keyboard.h, charset.h, coding.h.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
51211
diff
changeset
|
35 #include "coding.h" |
49323 | 36 #include <gdk/gdkkeysyms.h> |
108082
38a6893c8b9e
* gtkutil.c: Include xsettings.h for Ftool_bar_get_system_style.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
108024
diff
changeset
|
37 #include "xsettings.h" |
49323 | 38 |
97059
984f2ac5a637
* lisp.h (init_weak_hash_tables, syms_of_font)
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
97056
diff
changeset
|
39 #ifdef HAVE_XFT |
984f2ac5a637
* lisp.h (init_weak_hash_tables, syms_of_font)
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
97056
diff
changeset
|
40 #include <X11/Xft/Xft.h> |
984f2ac5a637
* lisp.h (init_weak_hash_tables, syms_of_font)
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
97056
diff
changeset
|
41 #endif |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
42 |
49323 | 43 #define FRAME_TOTAL_PIXEL_HEIGHT(f) \ |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
44 (FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f)) |
50129
d0142038feaa
Reduce flicker in GTK scrollbars.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50112
diff
changeset
|
45 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
46 #define FRAME_TOTAL_PIXEL_WIDTH(f) \ |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
47 (FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
48 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
49 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_WIDGET_SET_HAS_WINDOW |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
50 #define gtk_widget_set_has_window(w, b) \ |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
51 (gtk_fixed_set_has_window (GTK_FIXED (w), b)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
52 #endif |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
53 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_DIALOG_GET_ACTION_AREA |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
54 #define gtk_dialog_get_action_area(w) ((w)->action_area) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
55 #define gtk_dialog_get_content_area(w) ((w)->vbox) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
56 #endif |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
57 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_WIDGET_GET_SENSITIVE |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
58 #define gtk_widget_get_sensitive(w) (GTK_WIDGET_SENSITIVE (w)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
59 #endif |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
60 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_ADJUSTMENT_GET_PAGE_SIZE |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
61 #define gtk_adjustment_set_page_size(w, s) ((w)->page_size = (s)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
62 #define gtk_adjustment_set_page_increment(w, s) ((w)->page_increment = (s)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
63 #define gtk_adjustment_get_step_increment(w) ((w)->step_increment) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
64 #define gtk_adjustment_set_step_increment(w, s) ((w)->step_increment = (s)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
65 #endif |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
66 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION > 2 || GTK_MINOR_VERSION > 11 |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
67 #define remove_submenu(w) gtk_menu_item_set_submenu ((w), NULL) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
68 #else |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
69 #define remove_submenu(w) gtk_menu_item_remove_submenu ((w)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
70 #endif |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
71 |
111991
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
72 #define XG_BIN_CHILD(x) gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (x)) |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
73 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
74 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
75 /*********************************************************************** |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
76 Display handling functions |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
77 ***********************************************************************/ |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
78 |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
79 /* Keep track of the default display, or NULL if there is none. Emacs |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
80 may close all its displays. */ |
84621 | 81 |
82 static GdkDisplay *gdpy_def; | |
83 | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
84 /* When the GTK widget W is to be created on a display for F that |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
85 is not the default display, set the display for W. |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
86 W can be a GtkMenu or a GtkWindow widget. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
87 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
88 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
89 xg_set_screen (GtkWidget *w, FRAME_PTR f) |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
90 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
91 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f) != GDK_DISPLAY ()) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
92 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
93 GdkDisplay *gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
94 GdkScreen *gscreen = gdk_display_get_default_screen (gdpy); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
95 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
96 if (GTK_IS_MENU (w)) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
97 gtk_menu_set_screen (GTK_MENU (w), gscreen); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
98 else |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
99 gtk_window_set_screen (GTK_WINDOW (w), gscreen); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
100 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
101 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
102 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
103 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
104 /* Open a display named by DISPLAY_NAME. The display is returned in *DPY. |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
105 *DPY is set to NULL if the display can't be opened. |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
106 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
107 Returns non-zero if display could be opened, zero if display could not |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
108 be opened, and less than zero if the GTK version doesn't support |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
109 multipe displays. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
110 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
111 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
112 xg_display_open (char *display_name, Display **dpy) |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
113 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
114 GdkDisplay *gdpy; |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
115 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
116 gdpy = gdk_display_open (display_name); |
102705
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
117 if (!gdpy_def && gdpy) |
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
118 { |
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
119 gdpy_def = gdpy; |
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
120 gdk_display_manager_set_default_display (gdk_display_manager_get (), |
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
121 gdpy); |
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
122 } |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
123 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
124 *dpy = gdpy ? GDK_DISPLAY_XDISPLAY (gdpy) : NULL; |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
125 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
126 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
127 |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
128 /* Close display DPY. */ |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
129 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
130 void |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
131 xg_display_close (Display *dpy) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
132 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
133 GdkDisplay *gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (dpy); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
134 |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
135 /* If this is the default display, try to change it before closing. |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
136 If there is no other display to use, gdpy_def is set to NULL, and |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
137 the next call to xg_display_open resets the default display. */ |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
138 if (gdk_display_get_default () == gdpy) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
139 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
140 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo; |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
141 GdkDisplay *gdpy_new = NULL; |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
142 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
143 /* Find another display. */ |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
144 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
145 if (dpyinfo->display != dpy) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
146 { |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
147 gdpy_new = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (dpyinfo->display); |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
148 gdk_display_manager_set_default_display (gdk_display_manager_get (), |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
149 gdpy_new); |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
150 break; |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
151 } |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
152 gdpy_def = gdpy_new; |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
153 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
154 |
72778
ab6be05ddfb1
* gtkutil.c (xg_display_close): Always change default display if needed,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72637
diff
changeset
|
155 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION == 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION < 10 |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
156 /* GTK 2.2-2.8 has a bug that makes gdk_display_close crash (bug |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
157 http://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). This way we |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
158 can continue running, but there will be memory leaks. */ |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
159 g_object_run_dispose (G_OBJECT (gdpy)); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
160 #else |
72778
ab6be05ddfb1
* gtkutil.c (xg_display_close): Always change default display if needed,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72637
diff
changeset
|
161 /* This seems to be fixed in GTK 2.10. */ |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
162 gdk_display_close (gdpy); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
163 #endif |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
164 } |
50129
d0142038feaa
Reduce flicker in GTK scrollbars.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50112
diff
changeset
|
165 |
49323 | 166 |
167 /*********************************************************************** | |
168 Utility functions | |
169 ***********************************************************************/ | |
170 /* The next two variables and functions are taken from lwlib. */ | |
171 static widget_value *widget_value_free_list; | |
172 static int malloc_cpt; | |
173 | |
174 /* Allocate a widget_value structure, either by taking one from the | |
175 widget_value_free_list or by malloc:ing a new one. | |
176 | |
177 Return a pointer to the allocated structure. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
178 |
49323 | 179 widget_value * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
180 malloc_widget_value (void) |
49323 | 181 { |
182 widget_value *wv; | |
183 if (widget_value_free_list) | |
184 { | |
185 wv = widget_value_free_list; | |
186 widget_value_free_list = wv->free_list; | |
187 wv->free_list = 0; | |
188 } | |
189 else | |
190 { | |
69025
5d9232b72d14
(malloc_widget_value): Use xmalloc.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
68922
diff
changeset
|
191 wv = (widget_value *) xmalloc (sizeof (widget_value)); |
49323 | 192 malloc_cpt++; |
193 } | |
194 memset (wv, 0, sizeof (widget_value)); | |
195 return wv; | |
196 } | |
197 | |
198 /* This is analogous to free. It frees only what was allocated | |
199 by malloc_widget_value, and no substructures. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
200 |
49323 | 201 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
202 free_widget_value (widget_value *wv) |
49323 | 203 { |
204 if (wv->free_list) | |
205 abort (); | |
206 | |
207 if (malloc_cpt > 25) | |
208 { | |
209 /* When the number of already allocated cells is too big, | |
210 We free it. */ | |
100633
5395c014feb8
* buffer.c (init_buffer): Use realloc instead of xrealloc.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
100501
diff
changeset
|
211 xfree (wv); |
49323 | 212 malloc_cpt--; |
213 } | |
214 else | |
215 { | |
216 wv->free_list = widget_value_free_list; | |
217 widget_value_free_list = wv; | |
218 } | |
219 } | |
220 | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
221 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
222 /* Create and return the cursor to be used for popup menus and |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
223 scroll bars on display DPY. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
224 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
225 GdkCursor * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
226 xg_create_default_cursor (Display *dpy) |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
227 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
228 GdkDisplay *gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (dpy); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
229 return gdk_cursor_new_for_display (gdpy, GDK_LEFT_PTR); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
230 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
231 |
64936
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
232 /* Apply GMASK to GPIX and return a GdkPixbuf with an alpha channel. */ |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
233 |
65006
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
234 static GdkPixbuf * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
235 xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask (GdkPixmap *gpix, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
236 GdkPixmap *gmask, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
237 GdkColormap *cmap) |
64936
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
238 { |
107219
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
239 int width, height; |
64936
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
240 GdkPixbuf *icon_buf, *tmp_buf; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
241 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
242 gdk_drawable_get_size (gpix, &width, &height); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
243 tmp_buf = gdk_pixbuf_get_from_drawable (NULL, gpix, cmap, |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
244 0, 0, 0, 0, width, height); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
245 icon_buf = gdk_pixbuf_add_alpha (tmp_buf, FALSE, 0, 0, 0); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
246 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (tmp_buf)); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
247 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
248 if (gmask) |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
249 { |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
250 GdkPixbuf *mask_buf = gdk_pixbuf_get_from_drawable (NULL, |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
251 gmask, |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
252 NULL, |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
253 0, 0, 0, 0, |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
254 width, height); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
255 guchar *pixels = gdk_pixbuf_get_pixels (icon_buf); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
256 guchar *mask_pixels = gdk_pixbuf_get_pixels (mask_buf); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
257 int rowstride = gdk_pixbuf_get_rowstride (icon_buf); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
258 int mask_rowstride = gdk_pixbuf_get_rowstride (mask_buf); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
259 int y; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
260 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
261 for (y = 0; y < height; ++y) |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
262 { |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
263 guchar *iconptr, *maskptr; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
264 int x; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
265 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
266 iconptr = pixels + y * rowstride; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
267 maskptr = mask_pixels + y * mask_rowstride; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
268 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
269 for (x = 0; x < width; ++x) |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
270 { |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
271 /* In a bitmap, RGB is either 255/255/255 or 0/0/0. Checking |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
272 just R is sufficient. */ |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
273 if (maskptr[0] == 0) |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
274 iconptr[3] = 0; /* 0, 1, 2 is R, G, B. 3 is alpha. */ |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
275 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
276 iconptr += rowstride/width; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
277 maskptr += mask_rowstride/width; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
278 } |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
279 } |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
280 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
281 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (mask_buf)); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
282 } |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
283 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
284 return icon_buf; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
285 } |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
286 |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
287 static Lisp_Object |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
288 file_for_image (Lisp_Object image) |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
289 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
290 Lisp_Object specified_file = Qnil; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
291 Lisp_Object tail; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
292 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
293 for (tail = XCDR (image); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
294 NILP (specified_file) && CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
295 tail = XCDR (XCDR (tail))) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
296 if (EQ (XCAR (tail), QCfile)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
297 specified_file = XCAR (XCDR (tail)); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
298 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
299 return specified_file; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
300 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
301 |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
302 /* For the image defined in IMG, make and return a GtkImage. For displays with |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
303 8 planes or less we must make a GdkPixbuf and apply the mask manually. |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
304 Otherwise the highlightning and dimming the tool bar code in GTK does |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
305 will look bad. For display with more than 8 planes we just use the |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
306 pixmap and mask directly. For monochrome displays, GTK doesn't seem |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
307 able to use external pixmaps, it looks bad whatever we do. |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
308 The image is defined on the display where frame F is. |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
309 WIDGET is used to find the GdkColormap to use for the GdkPixbuf. |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
310 If OLD_WIDGET is NULL, a new widget is constructed and returned. |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
311 If OLD_WIDGET is not NULL, that widget is modified. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
312 |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
313 static GtkWidget * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
314 xg_get_image_for_pixmap (FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
315 struct image *img, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
316 GtkWidget *widget, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
317 GtkImage *old_widget) |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
318 { |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
319 GdkPixmap *gpix; |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
320 GdkPixmap *gmask; |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
321 GdkDisplay *gdpy; |
78809
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
322 GdkColormap *cmap; |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
323 GdkPixbuf *icon_buf; |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
324 |
68027
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
325 /* If we have a file, let GTK do all the image handling. |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
326 This seems to be the only way to make insensitive and activated icons |
68027
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
327 look good in all cases. */ |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
328 Lisp_Object specified_file = file_for_image (img->spec); |
69141
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
329 Lisp_Object file; |
68027
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
330 |
69141
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
331 /* We already loaded the image once before calling this |
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
332 function, so this only fails if the image file has been removed. |
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
333 In that case, use the pixmap already loaded. */ |
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
334 |
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
335 if (STRINGP (specified_file) |
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
336 && STRINGP (file = x_find_image_file (specified_file))) |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
337 { |
68027
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
338 if (! old_widget) |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
339 old_widget = GTK_IMAGE (gtk_image_new_from_file (SSDATA (file))); |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
340 else |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
341 gtk_image_set_from_file (old_widget, SSDATA (file)); |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
342 |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
343 return GTK_WIDGET (old_widget); |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
344 } |
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
345 |
68027
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
346 /* No file, do the image handling ourselves. This will look very bad |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
347 on a monochrome display, and sometimes bad on all displays with |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
348 certain themes. */ |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
349 |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
350 gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)); |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
351 gpix = gdk_pixmap_foreign_new_for_display (gdpy, img->pixmap); |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
352 gmask = img->mask ? gdk_pixmap_foreign_new_for_display (gdpy, img->mask) : 0; |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
353 |
78809
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
354 /* This is a workaround to make icons look good on pseudo color |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
355 displays. Apparently GTK expects the images to have an alpha |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
356 channel. If they don't, insensitive and activated icons will |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
357 look bad. This workaround does not work on monochrome displays, |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
358 and is strictly not needed on true color/static color displays (i.e. |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
359 16 bits and higher). But we do it anyway so we get a pixbuf that is |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
360 not associated with the img->pixmap. The img->pixmap may be removed |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
361 by clearing the image cache and then the tool bar redraw fails, since |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
362 Gtk+ assumes the pixmap is always there. */ |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
363 cmap = gtk_widget_get_colormap (widget); |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
364 icon_buf = xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask (gpix, gmask, cmap); |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
365 |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
366 if (! old_widget) |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
367 old_widget = GTK_IMAGE (gtk_image_new_from_pixbuf (icon_buf)); |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
368 else |
78809
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
369 gtk_image_set_from_pixbuf (old_widget, icon_buf); |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
370 |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
371 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (icon_buf)); |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
372 |
56268
9853134cd610
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Call g_object_unref on
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56112
diff
changeset
|
373 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gpix)); |
9853134cd610
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Call g_object_unref on
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56112
diff
changeset
|
374 if (gmask) g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gmask)); |
9853134cd610
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Call g_object_unref on
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56112
diff
changeset
|
375 |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
376 return GTK_WIDGET (old_widget); |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
377 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
378 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
379 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
380 /* Set CURSOR on W and all widgets W contain. We must do like this |
49323 | 381 for scroll bars and menu because they create widgets internally, |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
382 and it is those widgets that are visible. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
383 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
384 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
385 xg_set_cursor (GtkWidget *w, GdkCursor *cursor) |
49323 | 386 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
387 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window(w); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
388 GList *children = gdk_window_peek_children (window); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
389 |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
390 gdk_window_set_cursor (window, cursor); |
49323 | 391 |
392 /* The scroll bar widget has more than one GDK window (had to look at | |
393 the source to figure this out), and there is no way to set cursor | |
394 on widgets in GTK. So we must set the cursor for all GDK windows. | |
395 Ditto for menus. */ | |
396 | |
397 for ( ; children; children = g_list_next (children)) | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
398 gdk_window_set_cursor (GDK_WINDOW (children->data), cursor); |
49323 | 399 } |
400 | |
401 /* Insert NODE into linked LIST. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
402 |
49323 | 403 static void |
404 xg_list_insert (xg_list_node *list, xg_list_node *node) | |
405 { | |
406 xg_list_node *list_start = list->next; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
407 |
49323 | 408 if (list_start) list_start->prev = node; |
409 node->next = list_start; | |
410 node->prev = 0; | |
411 list->next = node; | |
412 } | |
413 | |
414 /* Remove NODE from linked LIST. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
415 |
49323 | 416 static void |
417 xg_list_remove (xg_list_node *list, xg_list_node *node) | |
418 { | |
419 xg_list_node *list_start = list->next; | |
420 if (node == list_start) | |
421 { | |
422 list->next = node->next; | |
423 if (list->next) list->next->prev = 0; | |
424 } | |
425 else | |
426 { | |
427 node->prev->next = node->next; | |
428 if (node->next) node->next->prev = node->prev; | |
429 } | |
430 } | |
431 | |
432 /* Allocate and return a utf8 version of STR. If STR is already | |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
433 utf8 or NULL, just return a copy of STR. |
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
434 A new string is allocated and the caller must free the result |
49323 | 435 with g_free. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
436 |
49323 | 437 static char * |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
438 get_utf8_string (const char *str) |
49323 | 439 { |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
440 char *utf8_str; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
441 |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
442 if (!str) return NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
443 |
49323 | 444 /* If not UTF-8, try current locale. */ |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
445 if (!g_utf8_validate (str, -1, NULL)) |
49323 | 446 utf8_str = g_locale_to_utf8 (str, -1, 0, 0, 0); |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
447 else |
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
448 return g_strdup (str); |
49323 | 449 |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
450 if (!utf8_str) |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
451 { |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
452 /* Probably some control characters in str. Escape them. */ |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
453 size_t nr_bad = 0; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
454 gsize bytes_read; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
455 gsize bytes_written; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
456 unsigned char *p = (unsigned char *)str; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
457 char *cp, *up; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
458 GError *error = NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
459 |
73389
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
460 while (! (cp = g_locale_to_utf8 ((char *)p, -1, &bytes_read, |
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
461 &bytes_written, &error)) |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
462 && error->code == G_CONVERT_ERROR_ILLEGAL_SEQUENCE) |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
463 { |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
464 ++nr_bad; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
465 p += bytes_written+1; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
466 g_error_free (error); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
467 error = NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
468 } |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
469 |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
470 if (error) |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
471 { |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
472 g_error_free (error); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
473 error = NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
474 } |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
475 if (cp) g_free (cp); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
476 |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
477 up = utf8_str = xmalloc (strlen (str) + nr_bad * 4 + 1); |
73389
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
478 p = (unsigned char *)str; |
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
479 |
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
480 while (! (cp = g_locale_to_utf8 ((char *)p, -1, &bytes_read, |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
481 &bytes_written, &error)) |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
482 && error->code == G_CONVERT_ERROR_ILLEGAL_SEQUENCE) |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
483 { |
73389
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
484 strncpy (up, (char *)p, bytes_written); |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
485 sprintf (up + bytes_written, "\\%03o", p[bytes_written]); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
486 up[bytes_written+4] = '\0'; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
487 up += bytes_written+4; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
488 p += bytes_written+1; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
489 g_error_free (error); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
490 error = NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
491 } |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
492 |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
493 if (cp) |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
494 { |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
495 strcat (utf8_str, cp); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
496 g_free (cp); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
497 } |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
498 if (error) |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
499 { |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
500 g_error_free (error); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
501 error = NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
502 } |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
503 } |
49323 | 504 return utf8_str; |
505 } | |
506 | |
109749
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
507 /* Check for special colors used in face spec for region face. |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
508 The colors are fetched from the Gtk+ theme. |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
509 Return 1 if color was found, 0 if not. */ |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
510 |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
511 int |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
512 xg_check_special_colors (struct frame *f, |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
513 const char *color_name, |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
514 XColor *color) |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
515 { |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
516 int success_p = 0; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
517 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f)) |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
518 { |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
519 if (strcmp ("gtk_selection_bg_color", color_name) == 0) |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
520 { |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
521 GtkStyle *gsty = gtk_widget_get_style (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f)); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
522 color->red = gsty->bg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].red; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
523 color->green = gsty->bg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].green; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
524 color->blue = gsty->bg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].blue; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
525 color->pixel = gsty->bg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].pixel; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
526 success_p = 1; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
527 } |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
528 else if (strcmp ("gtk_selection_fg_color", color_name) == 0) |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
529 { |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
530 GtkStyle *gsty = gtk_widget_get_style (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f)); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
531 color->red = gsty->fg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].red; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
532 color->green = gsty->fg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].green; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
533 color->blue = gsty->fg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].blue; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
534 color->pixel = gsty->fg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].pixel; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
535 success_p = 1; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
536 } |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
537 } |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
538 |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
539 return success_p; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
540 } |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
541 |
49323 | 542 |
543 | |
544 /*********************************************************************** | |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
545 Tooltips |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
546 ***********************************************************************/ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
547 /* Gtk+ calls this callback when the parent of our tooltip dummy changes. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
548 We use that to pop down the tooltip. This happens if Gtk+ for some |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
549 reason wants to change or hide the tooltip. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
550 |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
551 #ifdef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
552 |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
553 static void |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
554 hierarchy_ch_cb (GtkWidget *widget, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
555 GtkWidget *previous_toplevel, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
556 gpointer user_data) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
557 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
558 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) user_data; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
559 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
560 GtkWidget *top = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (x->ttip_lbl); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
561 |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
562 if (! top || ! GTK_IS_WINDOW (top)) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
563 gtk_widget_hide (previous_toplevel); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
564 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
565 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
566 /* Callback called when Gtk+ thinks a tooltip should be displayed. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
567 We use it to get the tooltip window and the tooltip widget so |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
568 we can manipulate the ourselves. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
569 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
570 Return FALSE ensures that the tooltip is not shown. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
571 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
572 static gboolean |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
573 qttip_cb (GtkWidget *widget, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
574 gint xpos, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
575 gint ypos, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
576 gboolean keyboard_mode, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
577 GtkTooltip *tooltip, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
578 gpointer user_data) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
579 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
580 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) user_data; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
581 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
582 if (x->ttip_widget == NULL) |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
583 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
584 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (widget), "has-tooltip", FALSE, NULL); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
585 x->ttip_widget = tooltip; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
586 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (tooltip)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
587 x->ttip_lbl = gtk_label_new (""); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
588 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (x->ttip_lbl)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
589 gtk_tooltip_set_custom (tooltip, x->ttip_lbl); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
590 x->ttip_window = GTK_WINDOW (gtk_widget_get_toplevel (x->ttip_lbl)); |
111186
801b9f880236
* gtkutil.c (qttip_cb): Set title to empty for ATK (Bug#7278).
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
110683
diff
changeset
|
591 /* ATK needs an empty title for some reason. */ |
801b9f880236
* gtkutil.c (qttip_cb): Set title to empty for ATK (Bug#7278).
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
110683
diff
changeset
|
592 gtk_window_set_title (x->ttip_window, ""); |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
593 /* Realize so we can safely get screen later on. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
594 gtk_widget_realize (GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_window)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
595 gtk_widget_realize (x->ttip_lbl); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
596 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
597 g_signal_connect (x->ttip_lbl, "hierarchy-changed", |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
598 G_CALLBACK (hierarchy_ch_cb), f); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
599 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
600 return FALSE; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
601 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
602 |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
603 #endif /* USE_GTK_TOOLTIP */ |
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
604 |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
605 /* Prepare a tooltip to be shown, i.e. calculate WIDTH and HEIGHT. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
606 Return zero if no system tooltip available, non-zero otherwise. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
607 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
608 int |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
609 xg_prepare_tooltip (FRAME_PTR f, |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
610 Lisp_Object string, |
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
611 int *width, |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
612 int *height) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
613 { |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
614 #ifndef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
615 return 0; |
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
616 #else |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
617 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
618 GtkWidget *widget; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
619 GdkWindow *gwin; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
620 GdkScreen *screen; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
621 GtkSettings *settings; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
622 gboolean tt_enabled = TRUE; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
623 GtkRequisition req; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
624 Lisp_Object encoded_string; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
625 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
626 if (!x->ttip_lbl) return 0; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
627 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
628 BLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
629 encoded_string = ENCODE_UTF_8 (string); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
630 widget = GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_lbl); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
631 gwin = gtk_widget_get_window (GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_window)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
632 screen = gdk_drawable_get_screen (gwin); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
633 settings = gtk_settings_get_for_screen (screen); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
634 g_object_get (settings, "gtk-enable-tooltips", &tt_enabled, NULL); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
635 if (tt_enabled) |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
636 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
637 g_object_set (settings, "gtk-enable-tooltips", FALSE, NULL); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
638 /* Record that we disabled it so it can be enabled again. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
639 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (x->ttip_window), "restore-tt", |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
640 (gpointer)f); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
641 } |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
642 |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
643 /* Prevent Gtk+ from hiding tooltip on mouse move and such. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
644 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
645 (gtk_widget_get_display (GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_window))), |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
646 "gdk-display-current-tooltip", NULL); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
647 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
648 /* Put out dummy widget in so we can get callbacks for unrealize and |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
649 hierarchy-changed. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
650 gtk_tooltip_set_custom (x->ttip_widget, widget); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
651 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
652 gtk_tooltip_set_text (x->ttip_widget, SDATA (encoded_string)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
653 gtk_widget_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_window), &req); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
654 if (width) *width = req.width; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
655 if (height) *height = req.height; |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
656 |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
657 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
658 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
659 return 1; |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
660 #endif /* USE_GTK_TOOLTIP */ |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
661 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
662 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
663 /* Show the tooltip at ROOT_X and ROOT_Y. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
664 xg_prepare_tooltip must have been called before this function. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
665 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
666 void |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
667 xg_show_tooltip (FRAME_PTR f, int root_x, int root_y) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
668 { |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
669 #ifdef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
670 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
671 if (x->ttip_window) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
672 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
673 BLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
674 gtk_window_move (x->ttip_window, root_x, root_y); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
675 gtk_widget_show_all (GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_window)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
676 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
677 } |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
678 #endif |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
679 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
680 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
681 /* Hide tooltip if shown. Do nothing if not shown. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
682 Return non-zero if tip was hidden, non-ero if not (i.e. not using |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
683 system tooltips). */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
684 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
685 int |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
686 xg_hide_tooltip (FRAME_PTR f) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
687 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
688 int ret = 0; |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
689 #ifdef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
690 if (f->output_data.x->ttip_window) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
691 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
692 GtkWindow *win = f->output_data.x->ttip_window; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
693 BLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
694 gtk_widget_hide (GTK_WIDGET (win)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
695 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
696 if (g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (win), "restore-tt")) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
697 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
698 GdkWindow *gwin = gtk_widget_get_window (GTK_WIDGET (win)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
699 GdkScreen *screen = gdk_drawable_get_screen (gwin); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
700 GtkSettings *settings = gtk_settings_get_for_screen (screen); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
701 g_object_set (settings, "gtk-enable-tooltips", TRUE, NULL); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
702 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
703 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
704 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
705 ret = 1; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
706 } |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
707 #endif |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
708 return ret; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
709 } |
49323 | 710 |
711 | |
712 /*********************************************************************** | |
713 General functions for creating widgets, resizing, events, e.t.c. | |
714 ***********************************************************************/ | |
715 | |
716 /* Make a geometry string and pass that to GTK. It seems this is the | |
717 only way to get geometry position right if the user explicitly | |
718 asked for a position when starting Emacs. | |
719 F is the frame we shall set geometry for. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
720 |
49323 | 721 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
722 xg_set_geometry (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 723 { |
107851
2a74858bccc0
Fix so top -10 and left -10 in frame parameters work.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
724 if (f->size_hint_flags & (USPosition | PPosition)) |
93427
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
725 { |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
726 int left = f->left_pos; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
727 int xneg = f->size_hint_flags & XNegative; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
728 int top = f->top_pos; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
729 int yneg = f->size_hint_flags & YNegative; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
730 char geom_str[32]; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
731 |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
732 if (xneg) |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
733 left = -left; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
734 if (yneg) |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
735 top = -top; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
736 |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
737 sprintf (geom_str, "=%dx%d%c%d%c%d", |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
738 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), |
107891
bf5fce1e8e34
Set USER_POS in hint_flags to work around Cygwin problem.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107851
diff
changeset
|
739 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f), |
93427
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
740 (xneg ? '-' : '+'), left, |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
741 (yneg ? '-' : '+'), top); |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
742 |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
743 if (!gtk_window_parse_geometry (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)), |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
744 geom_str)) |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
745 fprintf (stderr, "Failed to parse: '%s'\n", geom_str); |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
746 } |
49323 | 747 } |
748 | |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
749 /* Clear under internal border if any. As we use a mix of Gtk+ and X calls |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
750 and use a GtkFixed widget, this doesn't happen automatically. */ |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
751 |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
752 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
753 xg_clear_under_internal_border (FRAME_PTR f) |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
754 { |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
755 if (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f) > 0) |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
756 { |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
757 GtkWidget *wfixed = f->output_data.x->edit_widget; |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
758 gtk_widget_queue_draw (wfixed); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
759 gdk_window_process_all_updates (); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
760 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
761 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
762 0, 0, |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
763 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
764 FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), 0); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
765 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
766 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
767 0, 0, |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
768 FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
769 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f), 0); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
770 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
771 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
772 0, FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
773 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
774 FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), 0); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
775 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
776 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
777 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
778 0, |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
779 FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
780 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f), 0); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
781 } |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
782 } |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
783 |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
784 /* Function to handle resize of our frame. As we have a Gtk+ tool bar |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
785 and a Gtk+ menu bar, we get resize events for the edit part of the |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
786 frame only. We let Gtk+ deal with the Gtk+ parts. |
49323 | 787 F is the frame to resize. |
788 PIXELWIDTH, PIXELHEIGHT is the new size in pixels. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
789 |
49323 | 790 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
791 xg_frame_resized (FRAME_PTR f, int pixelwidth, int pixelheight) |
49323 | 792 { |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
793 int rows, columns; |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
794 |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
795 if (pixelwidth == -1 && pixelheight == -1) |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
796 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
797 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f) && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
798 gdk_window_get_geometry (gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f)), |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
799 0, 0, |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
800 &pixelwidth, &pixelheight, 0); |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
801 else return; |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
802 } |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
803 |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
804 |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
805 rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelheight); |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
806 columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, pixelwidth); |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
807 |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
808 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f) |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
809 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f) |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
810 || pixelwidth != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
811 || pixelheight != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) |
49323 | 812 { |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
813 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth; |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
814 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight; |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
815 |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
816 xg_clear_under_internal_border (f); |
100498
b5964e7e169b
(xg_frame_resized): Remove check if rows/columns have
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
100100
diff
changeset
|
817 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0); |
b5964e7e169b
(xg_frame_resized): Remove check if rows/columns have
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
100100
diff
changeset
|
818 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
b5964e7e169b
(xg_frame_resized): Remove check if rows/columns have
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
100100
diff
changeset
|
819 cancel_mouse_face (f); |
49323 | 820 } |
821 } | |
822 | |
93427
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
823 /* Resize the outer window of frame F after chainging the height. |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
824 COLUMNS/ROWS is the size the edit area shall have after the resize. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
825 |
49323 | 826 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
827 xg_frame_set_char_size (FRAME_PTR f, int cols, int rows) |
49323 | 828 { |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
829 int pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows) |
49323 | 830 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f); |
50318
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
831 int pixelwidth; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
832 |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
833 if (FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) == 0) |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
834 return; |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
835 |
49323 | 836 /* Take into account the size of the scroll bar. Always use the |
837 number of columns occupied by the scroll bar here otherwise we | |
838 might end up with a frame width that is not a multiple of the | |
839 frame's character width which is bad for vertically split | |
840 windows. */ | |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
841 f->scroll_bar_actual_width |
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
842 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f); |
49323 | 843 |
50099
a62497b91c74
Use generic compute_fringe_widths.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50063
diff
changeset
|
844 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0); |
49323 | 845 |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
846 /* FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH uses scroll_bar_actual_width, so call it |
50318
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
847 after calculating that value. */ |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
848 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
849 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f); |
50318
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
850 |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
851 |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
852 /* Do this before resize, as we don't know yet if we will be resized. */ |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
853 xg_clear_under_internal_border (f); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
854 |
49323 | 855 /* Must resize our top level widget. Font size may have changed, |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
856 but not rows/cols. */ |
49323 | 857 gtk_window_resize (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)), |
858 pixelwidth, pixelheight); | |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
859 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, 0); |
103198
f63bce93c7a1
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Set frame pixel width/height to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103022
diff
changeset
|
860 |
105693
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
861 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
862 cancel_mouse_face (f); |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
863 |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
864 /* We can not call change_frame_size for a mapped frame, |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
865 we can not set pixel width/height either. The window manager may |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
866 override our resize request, XMonad does this all the time. |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
867 The best we can do is try to sync, so lisp code sees the updated |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
868 size as fast as possible. |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
869 For unmapped windows, we can set rows/cols. When |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
870 the frame is mapped again we will (hopefully) get the correct size. */ |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
871 if (f->async_visible) |
105693
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
872 { |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
873 /* Must call this to flush out events */ |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
874 (void)gtk_events_pending (); |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
875 gdk_flush (); |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
876 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify); |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
877 } |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
878 else |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
879 { |
105693
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
880 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0); |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
881 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth; |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
882 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight; |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
883 } |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
884 } |
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
885 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
886 /* Handle height/width changes (i.e. add/remove/move menu/toolbar). |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
887 The policy is to keep the number of editable lines. */ |
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
888 |
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
889 static void |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
890 xg_height_or_width_changed (FRAME_PTR f) |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
891 { |
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
892 gtk_window_resize (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)), |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
893 FRAME_TOTAL_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
894 FRAME_TOTAL_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)); |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
895 f->output_data.x->hint_flags = 0; |
53275
a07a0bae1990
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Call x_wm_set_size_hint.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
53069
diff
changeset
|
896 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, 0); |
49323 | 897 } |
898 | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
899 /* Convert an X Window WSESC on display DPY to its corresponding GtkWidget. |
49323 | 900 Must be done like this, because GtkWidget:s can have "hidden" |
901 X Window that aren't accessible. | |
902 | |
903 Return 0 if no widget match WDESC. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
904 |
49323 | 905 GtkWidget * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
906 xg_win_to_widget (Display *dpy, Window wdesc) |
49323 | 907 { |
908 gpointer gdkwin; | |
909 GtkWidget *gwdesc = 0; | |
910 | |
911 BLOCK_INPUT; | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
912 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
913 gdkwin = gdk_xid_table_lookup_for_display (gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (dpy), |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
914 wdesc); |
49323 | 915 if (gdkwin) |
916 { | |
917 GdkEvent event; | |
918 event.any.window = gdkwin; | |
919 gwdesc = gtk_get_event_widget (&event); | |
920 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
921 |
49323 | 922 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
923 return gwdesc; | |
924 } | |
925 | |
926 /* Fill in the GdkColor C so that it represents PIXEL. | |
927 W is the widget that color will be used for. Used to find colormap. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
928 |
49323 | 929 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
930 xg_pix_to_gcolor (GtkWidget *w, long unsigned int pixel, GdkColor *c) |
49323 | 931 { |
932 GdkColormap *map = gtk_widget_get_colormap (w); | |
933 gdk_colormap_query_color (map, pixel, c); | |
934 } | |
935 | |
109749
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
936 /* Callback called when the gtk theme changes. |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
937 We notify lisp code so it can fix faces used for region for example. */ |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
938 |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
939 static void |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
940 style_changed_cb (GObject *go, |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
941 GParamSpec *spec, |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
942 gpointer user_data) |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
943 { |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
944 struct input_event event; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
945 GdkDisplay *gdpy = (GdkDisplay *) user_data; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
946 const char *display_name = gdk_display_get_name (gdpy); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
947 |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
948 EVENT_INIT (event); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
949 event.kind = CONFIG_CHANGED_EVENT; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
950 event.frame_or_window = make_string (display_name, strlen (display_name)); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
951 /* Theme doesn't change often, so intern is called seldom. */ |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
952 event.arg = intern ("theme-name"); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
953 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
954 } |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
955 |
49323 | 956 /* Create and set up the GTK widgets for frame F. |
957 Return 0 if creation failed, non-zero otherwise. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
958 |
49323 | 959 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
960 xg_create_frame_widgets (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 961 { |
962 GtkWidget *wtop; | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
963 GtkWidget *wvbox, *whbox; |
49323 | 964 GtkWidget *wfixed; |
965 GdkColor bg; | |
966 GtkRcStyle *style; | |
967 char *title = 0; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
968 |
49323 | 969 BLOCK_INPUT; |
970 | |
91632
370f67c176eb
(xg_create_frame_widgets): If frame is embedded, call
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
971 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)) |
370f67c176eb
(xg_create_frame_widgets): If frame is embedded, call
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
972 wtop = gtk_plug_new (f->output_data.x->parent_desc); |
370f67c176eb
(xg_create_frame_widgets): If frame is embedded, call
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
973 else |
370f67c176eb
(xg_create_frame_widgets): If frame is embedded, call
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
974 wtop = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL); |
370f67c176eb
(xg_create_frame_widgets): If frame is embedded, call
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
975 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
976 xg_set_screen (wtop, f); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
977 |
49323 | 978 wvbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
979 whbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
49323 | 980 wfixed = gtk_fixed_new (); /* Must have this to place scroll bars */ |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
981 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
982 if (! wtop || ! wvbox || ! whbox || ! wfixed) |
49323 | 983 { |
984 if (wtop) gtk_widget_destroy (wtop); | |
985 if (wvbox) gtk_widget_destroy (wvbox); | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
986 if (whbox) gtk_widget_destroy (whbox); |
49323 | 987 if (wfixed) gtk_widget_destroy (wfixed); |
988 | |
60185
391f44959566
(xg_create_frame_widgets): UNBLOCK_INPUT on error.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59913
diff
changeset
|
989 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
49323 | 990 return 0; |
991 } | |
992 | |
993 /* Use same names as the Xt port does. I.e. Emacs.pane.emacs by default */ | |
994 gtk_widget_set_name (wtop, EMACS_CLASS); | |
995 gtk_widget_set_name (wvbox, "pane"); | |
67528
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
996 gtk_widget_set_name (wfixed, SSDATA (Vx_resource_name)); |
49323 | 997 |
998 /* If this frame has a title or name, set it in the title bar. */ | |
67528
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
999 if (! NILP (f->title)) title = SSDATA (ENCODE_UTF_8 (f->title)); |
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
1000 else if (! NILP (f->name)) title = SSDATA (ENCODE_UTF_8 (f->name)); |
49323 | 1001 |
1002 if (title) gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (wtop), title); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1003 |
49323 | 1004 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = wtop; |
1005 FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f) = wfixed; | |
1006 f->output_data.x->vbox_widget = wvbox; | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
1007 f->output_data.x->hbox_widget = whbox; |
49323 | 1008 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1009 gtk_widget_set_has_window (wfixed, TRUE); |
49323 | 1010 |
1011 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (wtop), wvbox); | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
1012 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wvbox), whbox, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
1013 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (whbox), wfixed, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
49323 | 1014 |
1015 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f)) | |
1016 update_frame_tool_bar (f); | |
1017 | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
1018 /* We don't want this widget double buffered, because we draw on it |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
1019 with regular X drawing primitives, so from a GTK/GDK point of |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
1020 view, the widget is totally blank. When an expose comes, this |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
1021 will make the widget blank, and then Emacs redraws it. This flickers |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
1022 a lot, so we turn off double buffering. */ |
49323 | 1023 gtk_widget_set_double_buffered (wfixed, FALSE); |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
1024 |
49323 | 1025 gtk_window_set_wmclass (GTK_WINDOW (wtop), |
67528
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
1026 SSDATA (Vx_resource_name), |
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
1027 SSDATA (Vx_resource_class)); |
49323 | 1028 |
1029 /* Add callback to do nothing on WM_DELETE_WINDOW. The default in | |
1030 GTK is to destroy the widget. We want Emacs to do that instead. */ | |
1031 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wtop), "delete-event", | |
1032 G_CALLBACK (gtk_true), 0); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1033 |
49323 | 1034 /* Convert our geometry parameters into a geometry string |
1035 and specify it. | |
1036 GTK will itself handle calculating the real position this way. */ | |
1037 xg_set_geometry (f); | |
107219
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1038 f->win_gravity |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1039 = gtk_window_get_gravity (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))); |
49323 | 1040 |
1041 gtk_widget_add_events (wfixed, | |
1042 GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK | |
1043 | GDK_EXPOSURE_MASK | |
1044 | GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK | |
1045 | GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE_MASK | |
1046 | GDK_KEY_PRESS_MASK | |
1047 | GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY_MASK | |
1048 | GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY_MASK | |
1049 | GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE_MASK | |
1050 | GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK | |
1051 | GDK_VISIBILITY_NOTIFY_MASK); | |
1052 | |
1053 /* Must realize the windows so the X window gets created. It is used | |
1054 by callers of this function. */ | |
1055 gtk_widget_realize (wfixed); | |
1056 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = GTK_WIDGET_TO_X_WIN (wfixed); | |
1057 | |
1058 /* Since GTK clears its window by filling with the background color, | |
1059 we must keep X and GTK background in sync. */ | |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
1060 xg_pix_to_gcolor (wfixed, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f), &bg); |
49323 | 1061 gtk_widget_modify_bg (wfixed, GTK_STATE_NORMAL, &bg); |
1062 | |
1063 /* Also, do not let any background pixmap to be set, this looks very | |
1064 bad as Emacs overwrites the background pixmap with its own idea | |
1065 of background color. */ | |
1066 style = gtk_widget_get_modifier_style (wfixed); | |
1067 | |
1068 /* Must use g_strdup because gtk_widget_modify_style does g_free. */ | |
1069 style->bg_pixmap_name[GTK_STATE_NORMAL] = g_strdup ("<none>"); | |
1070 gtk_widget_modify_style (wfixed, style); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1071 |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
1072 #ifdef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1073 /* Steal a tool tip window we can move ourselves. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1074 f->output_data.x->ttip_widget = 0; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1075 f->output_data.x->ttip_lbl = 0; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1076 f->output_data.x->ttip_window = 0; |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
1077 gtk_widget_set_tooltip_text (wtop, "Dummy text"); |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1078 g_signal_connect (wtop, "query-tooltip", G_CALLBACK (qttip_cb), f); |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
1079 #endif |
49323 | 1080 |
109749
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1081 { |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1082 GdkScreen *screen = gtk_widget_get_screen (wtop); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1083 GtkSettings *gs = gtk_settings_get_for_screen (screen); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1084 /* Only connect this signal once per screen. */ |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1085 if (! g_signal_handler_find (G_OBJECT (gs), |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1086 G_SIGNAL_MATCH_FUNC, |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1087 0, 0, 0, |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1088 G_CALLBACK (style_changed_cb), |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1089 0)) |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1090 { |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1091 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (gs), "notify::gtk-theme-name", |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1092 G_CALLBACK (style_changed_cb), |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1093 gdk_screen_get_display (screen)); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1094 } |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1095 } |
49323 | 1096 |
1097 UNBLOCK_INPUT; | |
1098 | |
1099 return 1; | |
1100 } | |
1101 | |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1102 void |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1103 xg_free_frame_widgets (FRAME_PTR f) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1104 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1105 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1106 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1107 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1108 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1109 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow in xterm.c */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1110 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0; |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
1111 #ifdef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1112 if (x->ttip_lbl) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1113 gtk_widget_destroy (x->ttip_lbl); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1114 if (x->ttip_widget) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1115 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (x->ttip_widget)); |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
1116 #endif |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1117 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1118 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1119 |
49323 | 1120 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F. |
1121 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags | |
1122 that the window now has. | |
1123 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the User Position | |
1124 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0). */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1125 |
49323 | 1126 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1127 x_wm_set_size_hint (FRAME_PTR f, long int flags, int user_position) |
49323 | 1128 { |
98545
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1129 /* Must use GTK routines here, otherwise GTK resets the size hints |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1130 to its own defaults. */ |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1131 GdkGeometry size_hints; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1132 gint hint_flags = 0; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1133 int base_width, base_height; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1134 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1135 int win_gravity = f->win_gravity; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1136 |
107219
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1137 /* Don't set size hints during initialization; that apparently leads |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1138 to a race condition. See the thread at |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1139 http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/emacs-devel/2008-10/msg00033.html */ |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1140 if (NILP (Vafter_init_time) || !FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)) |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1141 return; |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1142 |
98545
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1143 if (flags) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1144 { |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1145 memset (&size_hints, 0, sizeof (size_hints)); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1146 f->output_data.x->size_hints = size_hints; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1147 f->output_data.x->hint_flags = hint_flags; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1148 } |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1149 else |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1150 flags = f->size_hint_flags; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1151 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1152 size_hints = f->output_data.x->size_hints; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1153 hint_flags = f->output_data.x->hint_flags; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1154 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1155 hint_flags |= GDK_HINT_RESIZE_INC | GDK_HINT_MIN_SIZE; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1156 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1157 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1158 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1159 hint_flags |= GDK_HINT_BASE_SIZE; |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
1160 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f); |
98545
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1161 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1162 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1163 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1164 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1165 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1166 size_hints.base_width = base_width; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1167 size_hints.base_height = base_height; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1168 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1169 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1170 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1171 /* These currently have a one to one mapping with the X values, but I |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1172 don't think we should rely on that. */ |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1173 hint_flags |= GDK_HINT_WIN_GRAVITY; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1174 size_hints.win_gravity = 0; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1175 if (win_gravity == NorthWestGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1176 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_NORTH_WEST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1177 else if (win_gravity == NorthGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1178 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_NORTH; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1179 else if (win_gravity == NorthEastGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1180 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_NORTH_EAST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1181 else if (win_gravity == WestGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1182 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_WEST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1183 else if (win_gravity == CenterGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1184 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_CENTER; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1185 else if (win_gravity == EastGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1186 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_EAST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1187 else if (win_gravity == SouthWestGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1188 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_SOUTH_WEST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1189 else if (win_gravity == SouthGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1190 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_SOUTH; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1191 else if (win_gravity == SouthEastGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1192 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_SOUTH_EAST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1193 else if (win_gravity == StaticGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1194 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_STATIC; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1195 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1196 if (user_position) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1197 { |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1198 hint_flags &= ~GDK_HINT_POS; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1199 hint_flags |= GDK_HINT_USER_POS; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1200 } |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1201 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1202 if (hint_flags != f->output_data.x->hint_flags |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1203 || memcmp (&size_hints, |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1204 &f->output_data.x->size_hints, |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1205 sizeof (size_hints)) != 0) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1206 { |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1207 BLOCK_INPUT; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1208 gtk_window_set_geometry_hints (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)), |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1209 NULL, &size_hints, hint_flags); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1210 f->output_data.x->size_hints = size_hints; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1211 f->output_data.x->hint_flags = hint_flags; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1212 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1213 } |
49323 | 1214 } |
1215 | |
1216 /* Change background color of a frame. | |
96363
f9d35151b907
American English spelling fix.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
95954
diff
changeset
|
1217 Since GTK uses the background color to clear the window, we must |
49323 | 1218 keep the GTK and X colors in sync. |
1219 F is the frame to change, | |
1220 BG is the pixel value to change to. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1221 |
49323 | 1222 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1223 xg_set_background_color (FRAME_PTR f, long unsigned int bg) |
49323 | 1224 { |
1225 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f)) | |
1226 { | |
1227 GdkColor gdk_bg; | |
1228 | |
1229 BLOCK_INPUT; | |
1230 xg_pix_to_gcolor (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f), bg, &gdk_bg); | |
1231 gtk_widget_modify_bg (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f), GTK_STATE_NORMAL, &gdk_bg); | |
1232 UNBLOCK_INPUT; | |
1233 } | |
1234 } | |
1235 | |
1236 | |
65006
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1237 /* Set the frame icon to ICON_PIXMAP/MASK. This must be done with GTK |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1238 functions so GTK does not overwrite the icon. */ |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1239 |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1240 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1241 xg_set_frame_icon (FRAME_PTR f, Pixmap icon_pixmap, Pixmap icon_mask) |
65006
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1242 { |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1243 GdkDisplay *gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)); |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1244 GdkPixmap *gpix = gdk_pixmap_foreign_new_for_display (gdpy, icon_pixmap); |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1245 GdkPixmap *gmask = gdk_pixmap_foreign_new_for_display (gdpy, icon_mask); |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1246 GdkPixbuf *gp = xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask (gpix, gmask, NULL); |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1247 |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1248 gtk_window_set_icon (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)), gp); |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1249 } |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1250 |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1251 |
49323 | 1252 |
1253 /*********************************************************************** | |
1254 Dialog functions | |
1255 ***********************************************************************/ | |
1256 /* Return the dialog title to use for a dialog of type KEY. | |
1257 This is the encoding used by lwlib. We use the same for GTK. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1258 |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
1259 static const char * |
49323 | 1260 get_dialog_title (char key) |
1261 { | |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
1262 const char *title = ""; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1263 |
49323 | 1264 switch (key) { |
1265 case 'E': case 'e': | |
1266 title = "Error"; | |
1267 break; | |
1268 | |
1269 case 'I': case 'i': | |
1270 title = "Information"; | |
1271 break; | |
1272 | |
1273 case 'L': case 'l': | |
1274 title = "Prompt"; | |
1275 break; | |
1276 | |
1277 case 'P': case 'p': | |
1278 title = "Prompt"; | |
1279 break; | |
1280 | |
1281 case 'Q': case 'q': | |
1282 title = "Question"; | |
1283 break; | |
1284 } | |
1285 | |
1286 return title; | |
1287 } | |
1288 | |
1289 /* Callback for dialogs that get WM_DELETE_WINDOW. We pop down | |
1290 the dialog, but return TRUE so the event does not propagate further | |
1291 in GTK. This prevents GTK from destroying the dialog widget automatically | |
1292 and we can always destrou the widget manually, regardles of how | |
1293 it was popped down (button press or WM_DELETE_WINDOW). | |
1294 W is the dialog widget. | |
1295 EVENT is the GdkEvent that represents WM_DELETE_WINDOW (not used). | |
1296 user_data is NULL (not used). | |
1297 | |
1298 Returns TRUE to end propagation of event. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1299 |
49323 | 1300 static gboolean |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1301 dialog_delete_callback (GtkWidget *w, GdkEvent *event, gpointer user_data) |
49323 | 1302 { |
1303 gtk_widget_unmap (w); | |
1304 return TRUE; | |
1305 } | |
1306 | |
1307 /* Create a popup dialog window. See also xg_create_widget below. | |
1308 WV is a widget_value describing the dialog. | |
1309 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a button has been pressed. | |
1310 DEACTIVATE_CB is the callback to use when the dialog pops down. | |
1311 | |
1312 Returns the GTK dialog widget. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1313 |
49323 | 1314 static GtkWidget * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1315 create_dialog (widget_value *wv, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1316 GCallback select_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1317 GCallback deactivate_cb) |
49323 | 1318 { |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
1319 const char *title = get_dialog_title (wv->name[0]); |
49323 | 1320 int total_buttons = wv->name[1] - '0'; |
1321 int right_buttons = wv->name[4] - '0'; | |
1322 int left_buttons; | |
1323 int button_nr = 0; | |
1324 int button_spacing = 10; | |
1325 GtkWidget *wdialog = gtk_dialog_new (); | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1326 GtkDialog *wd = GTK_DIALOG (wdialog); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1327 GtkBox *cur_box = GTK_BOX (gtk_dialog_get_action_area (wd)); |
49323 | 1328 widget_value *item; |
1329 GtkWidget *wvbox; | |
1330 GtkWidget *whbox_up; | |
1331 GtkWidget *whbox_down; | |
1332 | |
1333 /* If the number of buttons is greater than 4, make two rows of buttons | |
1334 instead. This looks better. */ | |
1335 int make_two_rows = total_buttons > 4; | |
1336 | |
1337 if (right_buttons == 0) right_buttons = total_buttons/2; | |
1338 left_buttons = total_buttons - right_buttons; | |
1339 | |
1340 gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (wdialog), title); | |
1341 gtk_widget_set_name (wdialog, "emacs-dialog"); | |
1342 | |
1343 | |
1344 if (make_two_rows) | |
1345 { | |
1346 wvbox = gtk_vbox_new (TRUE, button_spacing); | |
1347 whbox_up = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0); | |
1348 whbox_down = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0); | |
1349 | |
1350 gtk_box_pack_start (cur_box, wvbox, FALSE, FALSE, 0); | |
1351 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wvbox), whbox_up, FALSE, FALSE, 0); | |
1352 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wvbox), whbox_down, FALSE, FALSE, 0); | |
1353 | |
1354 cur_box = GTK_BOX (whbox_up); | |
1355 } | |
1356 | |
1357 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wdialog), "delete-event", | |
1358 G_CALLBACK (dialog_delete_callback), 0); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1359 |
49323 | 1360 if (deactivate_cb) |
1361 { | |
1362 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wdialog), "close", deactivate_cb, 0); | |
1363 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wdialog), "response", deactivate_cb, 0); | |
1364 } | |
1365 | |
1366 for (item = wv->contents; item; item = item->next) | |
1367 { | |
1368 char *utf8_label = get_utf8_string (item->value); | |
1369 GtkWidget *w; | |
1370 GtkRequisition req; | |
1371 | |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
1372 if (item->name && strcmp (item->name, "message") == 0) |
49323 | 1373 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1374 GtkBox *wvbox = GTK_BOX (gtk_dialog_get_content_area (wd)); |
49323 | 1375 /* This is the text part of the dialog. */ |
1376 w = gtk_label_new (utf8_label); | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1377 gtk_box_pack_start (wvbox, gtk_label_new (""), FALSE, FALSE, 0); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1378 gtk_box_pack_start (wvbox, w, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
49323 | 1379 gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (w), 0.1, 0.5); |
1380 | |
1381 /* Try to make dialog look better. Must realize first so | |
1382 the widget can calculate the size it needs. */ | |
1383 gtk_widget_realize (w); | |
1384 gtk_widget_size_request (w, &req); | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1385 gtk_box_set_spacing (wvbox, req.height); |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
1386 if (item->value && strlen (item->value) > 0) |
49323 | 1387 button_spacing = 2*req.width/strlen (item->value); |
1388 } | |
1389 else | |
1390 { | |
1391 /* This is one button to add to the dialog. */ | |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
1392 w = gtk_button_new_with_label (utf8_label); |
49323 | 1393 if (! item->enabled) |
1394 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (w, FALSE); | |
1395 if (select_cb) | |
1396 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), "clicked", | |
1397 select_cb, item->call_data); | |
1398 | |
1399 gtk_box_pack_start (cur_box, w, TRUE, TRUE, button_spacing); | |
1400 if (++button_nr == left_buttons) | |
1401 { | |
1402 if (make_two_rows) | |
1403 cur_box = GTK_BOX (whbox_down); | |
1404 else | |
1405 gtk_box_pack_start (cur_box, | |
1406 gtk_label_new (""), | |
1407 TRUE, TRUE, | |
1408 button_spacing); | |
1409 } | |
1410 } | |
1411 | |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
1412 if (utf8_label) |
49323 | 1413 g_free (utf8_label); |
1414 } | |
1415 | |
1416 return wdialog; | |
1417 } | |
1418 | |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1419 struct xg_dialog_data |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1420 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1421 GMainLoop *loop; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1422 int response; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1423 GtkWidget *w; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1424 guint timerid; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1425 }; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1426 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1427 /* Function that is called when the file or font dialogs pop down. |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1428 W is the dialog widget, RESPONSE is the response code. |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1429 USER_DATA is what we passed in to g_signal_connect. */ |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1430 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1431 static void |
109139
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1432 xg_dialog_response_cb (GtkDialog *w, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1433 gint response, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1434 gpointer user_data) |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1435 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1436 struct xg_dialog_data *dd = (struct xg_dialog_data *)user_data; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1437 dd->response = response; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1438 g_main_loop_quit (dd->loop); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1439 } |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1440 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1441 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1442 /* Destroy the dialog. This makes it pop down. */ |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1443 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1444 static Lisp_Object |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1445 pop_down_dialog (Lisp_Object arg) |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1446 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1447 struct Lisp_Save_Value *p = XSAVE_VALUE (arg); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1448 struct xg_dialog_data *dd = (struct xg_dialog_data *) p->pointer; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1449 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1450 BLOCK_INPUT; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1451 if (dd->w) gtk_widget_destroy (dd->w); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1452 if (dd->timerid != 0) g_source_remove (dd->timerid); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1453 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1454 g_main_loop_quit (dd->loop); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1455 g_main_loop_unref (dd->loop); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
1456 |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1457 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1458 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1459 return Qnil; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1460 } |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1461 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1462 /* If there are any emacs timers pending, add a timeout to main loop in DATA. |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1463 We pass in DATA as gpointer* so we can use this as a callback. */ |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1464 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1465 static gboolean |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1466 xg_maybe_add_timer (gpointer data) |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1467 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1468 struct xg_dialog_data *dd = (struct xg_dialog_data *) data; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1469 EMACS_TIME next_time = timer_check (1); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1470 long secs = EMACS_SECS (next_time); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1471 long usecs = EMACS_USECS (next_time); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1472 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1473 dd->timerid = 0; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1474 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1475 if (secs >= 0 && usecs >= 0 && secs < ((guint)-1)/1000) |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1476 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1477 dd->timerid = g_timeout_add (secs * 1000 + usecs/1000, |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1478 xg_maybe_add_timer, |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1479 dd); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1480 } |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1481 return FALSE; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1482 } |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1483 |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
1484 |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1485 /* Pops up a modal dialog W and waits for response. |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1486 We don't use gtk_dialog_run because we want to process emacs timers. |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1487 The dialog W is not destroyed when this function returns. */ |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1488 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1489 static int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1490 xg_dialog_run (FRAME_PTR f, GtkWidget *w) |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1491 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1492 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX (); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1493 struct xg_dialog_data dd; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1494 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1495 xg_set_screen (w, f); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1496 gtk_window_set_transient_for (GTK_WINDOW (w), |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1497 GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1498 gtk_window_set_destroy_with_parent (GTK_WINDOW (w), TRUE); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1499 gtk_window_set_modal (GTK_WINDOW (w), TRUE); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1500 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1501 dd.loop = g_main_loop_new (NULL, FALSE); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1502 dd.response = GTK_RESPONSE_CANCEL; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1503 dd.w = w; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1504 dd.timerid = 0; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1505 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1506 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1507 "response", |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1508 G_CALLBACK (xg_dialog_response_cb), |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1509 &dd); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1510 /* Don't destroy the widget if closed by the window manager close button. */ |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1511 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), "delete-event", G_CALLBACK (gtk_true), NULL); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1512 gtk_widget_show (w); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1513 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1514 record_unwind_protect (pop_down_dialog, make_save_value (&dd, 0)); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1515 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1516 (void) xg_maybe_add_timer (&dd); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1517 g_main_loop_run (dd.loop); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
1518 |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1519 dd.w = 0; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1520 unbind_to (count, Qnil); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1521 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1522 return dd.response; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1523 } |
49323 | 1524 |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1525 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1526 /*********************************************************************** |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1527 File dialog functions |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1528 ***********************************************************************/ |
67761
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1529 /* Return non-zero if the old file selection dialog is being used. |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1530 Return zero if not. */ |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1531 |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1532 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1533 xg_uses_old_file_dialog (void) |
67761
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1534 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1535 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW |
72963
e5e5fcf4397e
* gtkutil.c (xg_uses_old_file_dialog): Rename x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72931
diff
changeset
|
1536 return x_gtk_use_old_file_dialog; |
67761
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1537 #else |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1538 return 0; |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1539 #endif |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1540 } |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1541 |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1542 |
109100
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109067
diff
changeset
|
1543 typedef char * (*xg_get_file_func) (GtkWidget *); |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1544 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1545 /* Return the selected file for file chooser dialog W. |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1546 The returned string must be free:d. */ |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1547 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1548 static char * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1549 xg_get_file_name_from_chooser (GtkWidget *w) |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1550 { |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1551 return gtk_file_chooser_get_filename (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (w)); |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1552 } |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1553 |
68100
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1554 /* Callback called when the "Show hidden files" toggle is pressed. |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1555 WIDGET is the toggle widget, DATA is the file chooser dialog. */ |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1556 |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1557 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1558 xg_toggle_visibility_cb (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer data) |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1559 { |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1560 GtkFileChooser *dialog = GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (data); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1561 gboolean visible; |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1562 g_object_get (G_OBJECT (dialog), "show-hidden", &visible, NULL); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1563 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (dialog), "show-hidden", !visible, NULL); |
68100
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1564 } |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1565 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1566 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1567 /* Callback called when a property changes in a file chooser. |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1568 GOBJECT is the file chooser dialog, ARG1 describes the property. |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1569 USER_DATA is the toggle widget in the file chooser dialog. |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1570 We use this to update the "Show hidden files" toggle when the user |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1571 changes that property by right clicking in the file list. */ |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1572 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1573 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1574 xg_toggle_notify_cb (GObject *gobject, GParamSpec *arg1, gpointer user_data) |
68100
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1575 { |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1576 if (strcmp (arg1->name, "show-hidden") == 0) |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1577 { |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1578 GtkWidget *wtoggle = GTK_WIDGET (user_data); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1579 gboolean visible, toggle_on; |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1580 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1581 g_object_get (G_OBJECT (gobject), "show-hidden", &visible, NULL); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1582 toggle_on = gtk_toggle_button_get_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (wtoggle)); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1583 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1584 if (!!visible != !!toggle_on) |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1585 { |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1586 g_signal_handlers_block_by_func (G_OBJECT (wtoggle), |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1587 G_CALLBACK (xg_toggle_visibility_cb), |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1588 gobject); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1589 gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (wtoggle), visible); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1590 g_signal_handlers_unblock_by_func |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1591 (G_OBJECT (wtoggle), |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1592 G_CALLBACK (xg_toggle_visibility_cb), |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1593 gobject); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1594 } |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1595 x_gtk_show_hidden_files = visible; |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1596 } |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1597 } |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1598 |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1599 /* Read a file name from the user using a file chooser dialog. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1600 F is the current frame. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1601 PROMPT is a prompt to show to the user. May not be NULL. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1602 DEFAULT_FILENAME is a default selection to be displayed. May be NULL. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1603 If MUSTMATCH_P is non-zero, the returned file name must be an existing |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1604 file. *FUNC is set to a function that can be used to retrieve the |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1605 selected file name from the returned widget. |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1606 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1607 Returns the created widget. */ |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1608 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1609 static GtkWidget * |
109139
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1610 xg_get_file_with_chooser (FRAME_PTR f, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1611 char *prompt, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1612 char *default_filename, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1613 int mustmatch_p, int only_dir_p, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1614 xg_get_file_func *func) |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1615 { |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1616 char message[1024]; |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1617 |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1618 GtkWidget *filewin, *wtoggle, *wbox, *wmessage; |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1619 GtkWindow *gwin = GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)); |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1620 GtkFileChooserAction action = (mustmatch_p ? |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1621 GTK_FILE_CHOOSER_ACTION_OPEN : |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1622 GTK_FILE_CHOOSER_ACTION_SAVE); |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1623 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1624 if (only_dir_p) |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1625 action = GTK_FILE_CHOOSER_ACTION_SELECT_FOLDER; |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1626 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1627 filewin = gtk_file_chooser_dialog_new (prompt, gwin, action, |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1628 GTK_STOCK_CANCEL, GTK_RESPONSE_CANCEL, |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1629 (mustmatch_p || only_dir_p ? |
57900
a76858072e78
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Use GTK_STOCK_OK instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57868
diff
changeset
|
1630 GTK_STOCK_OPEN : GTK_STOCK_OK), |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1631 GTK_RESPONSE_OK, |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1632 NULL); |
58817
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1633 gtk_file_chooser_set_local_only (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (filewin), TRUE); |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1634 |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1635 wbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1636 gtk_widget_show (wbox); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1637 wtoggle = gtk_check_button_new_with_label ("Show hidden files."); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
1638 |
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
1639 if (x_gtk_show_hidden_files) |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1640 { |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1641 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (filewin), "show-hidden", TRUE, NULL); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1642 gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (wtoggle), TRUE); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1643 } |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1644 gtk_widget_show (wtoggle); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1645 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wtoggle), "clicked", |
68100
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1646 G_CALLBACK (xg_toggle_visibility_cb), filewin); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1647 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (filewin), "notify", |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1648 G_CALLBACK (xg_toggle_notify_cb), wtoggle); |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1649 |
72968
13a9a628ff21
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Rename x_gtk_show_chooser_help_text to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72963
diff
changeset
|
1650 if (x_gtk_file_dialog_help_text) |
72931
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1651 { |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1652 message[0] = '\0'; |
73048
4a83c4a89b5e
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Only chow C-l help for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72968
diff
changeset
|
1653 /* Gtk+ 2.10 has the file name text entry box integrated in the dialog. |
4a83c4a89b5e
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Only chow C-l help for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72968
diff
changeset
|
1654 Show the C-l help text only for versions < 2.10. */ |
73066 | 1655 if (gtk_check_version (2, 10, 0) && action != GTK_FILE_CHOOSER_ACTION_SAVE) |
72931
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1656 strcat (message, "\nType C-l to display a file name text entry box.\n"); |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1657 strcat (message, "\nIf you don't like this file selector, use the " |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1658 "corresponding\nkey binding or customize " |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1659 "use-file-dialog to turn it off."); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
1660 |
72931
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1661 wmessage = gtk_label_new (message); |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1662 gtk_widget_show (wmessage); |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1663 } |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1664 |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1665 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wbox), wtoggle, FALSE, FALSE, 0); |
72968
13a9a628ff21
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Rename x_gtk_show_chooser_help_text to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72963
diff
changeset
|
1666 if (x_gtk_file_dialog_help_text) |
72931
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1667 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wbox), wmessage, FALSE, FALSE, 0); |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1668 gtk_file_chooser_set_extra_widget (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (filewin), wbox); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1669 |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1670 if (default_filename) |
57940
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1671 { |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1672 Lisp_Object file; |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1673 struct gcpro gcpro1; |
78781
415fda17ec8f
(xg_get_file_with_chooser): Move GCPRO1 after declarations
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78762
diff
changeset
|
1674 char *utf8_filename; |
57940
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1675 GCPRO1 (file); |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1676 |
58817
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1677 file = build_string (default_filename); |
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1678 |
57940
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1679 /* File chooser does not understand ~/... in the file name. It must be |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1680 an absolute name starting with /. */ |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1681 if (default_filename[0] != '/') |
58817
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1682 file = Fexpand_file_name (file, Qnil); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
1683 |
72614
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1684 utf8_filename = SSDATA (ENCODE_UTF_8 (file)); |
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1685 if (! NILP (Ffile_directory_p (file))) |
58817
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1686 gtk_file_chooser_set_current_folder (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (filewin), |
72614
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1687 utf8_filename); |
58817
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1688 else |
72614
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1689 { |
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1690 gtk_file_chooser_set_filename (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (filewin), |
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1691 utf8_filename); |
72637
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1692 if (action == GTK_FILE_CHOOSER_ACTION_SAVE) |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1693 { |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1694 char *cp = strrchr (utf8_filename, '/'); |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1695 if (cp) ++cp; |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1696 else cp = utf8_filename; |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1697 gtk_file_chooser_set_current_name (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (filewin), cp); |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1698 } |
72614
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1699 } |
57940
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1700 |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1701 UNGCPRO; |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1702 } |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1703 |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1704 *func = xg_get_file_name_from_chooser; |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1705 return filewin; |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1706 } |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1707 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1708 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1709 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1710 /* Return the selected file for file selector dialog W. |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1711 The returned string must be free:d. */ |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1712 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1713 static char * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1714 xg_get_file_name_from_selector (GtkWidget *w) |
49323 | 1715 { |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1716 GtkFileSelection *filesel = GTK_FILE_SELECTION (w); |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1717 return xstrdup ((char*) gtk_file_selection_get_filename (filesel)); |
49323 | 1718 } |
1719 | |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1720 /* Create a file selection dialog. |
49323 | 1721 F is the current frame. |
1722 PROMPT is a prompt to show to the user. May not be NULL. | |
1723 DEFAULT_FILENAME is a default selection to be displayed. May be NULL. | |
1724 If MUSTMATCH_P is non-zero, the returned file name must be an existing | |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1725 file. *FUNC is set to a function that can be used to retrieve the |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1726 selected file name from the returned widget. |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1727 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1728 Returns the created widget. */ |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1729 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1730 static GtkWidget * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1731 xg_get_file_with_selection (FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1732 char *prompt, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1733 char *default_filename, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1734 int mustmatch_p, int only_dir_p, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1735 xg_get_file_func *func) |
49323 | 1736 { |
1737 GtkWidget *filewin; | |
1738 GtkFileSelection *filesel; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1739 |
49323 | 1740 filewin = gtk_file_selection_new (prompt); |
1741 filesel = GTK_FILE_SELECTION (filewin); | |
1742 | |
1743 if (default_filename) | |
1744 gtk_file_selection_set_filename (filesel, default_filename); | |
1745 | |
1746 if (mustmatch_p) | |
1747 { | |
1748 /* The selection_entry part of filesel is not documented. */ | |
1749 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (filesel->selection_entry, FALSE); | |
1750 gtk_file_selection_hide_fileop_buttons (filesel); | |
1751 } | |
1752 | |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1753 *func = xg_get_file_name_from_selector; |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1754 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1755 return filewin; |
49323 | 1756 } |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1757 #endif /* HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW */ |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1758 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1759 /* Read a file name from the user using a file dialog, either the old |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1760 file selection dialog, or the new file chooser dialog. Which to use |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1761 depends on what the GTK version used has, and what the value of |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1762 gtk-use-old-file-dialog. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1763 F is the current frame. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1764 PROMPT is a prompt to show to the user. May not be NULL. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1765 DEFAULT_FILENAME is a default selection to be displayed. May be NULL. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1766 If MUSTMATCH_P is non-zero, the returned file name must be an existing |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1767 file. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1768 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1769 Returns a file name or NULL if no file was selected. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1770 The returned string must be freed by the caller. */ |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1771 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1772 char * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1773 xg_get_file_name (FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1774 char *prompt, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1775 char *default_filename, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1776 int mustmatch_p, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1777 int only_dir_p) |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1778 { |
58284
10efc827e15c
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_name): Fix typo in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58201
diff
changeset
|
1779 GtkWidget *w = 0; |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1780 char *fn = 0; |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1781 int filesel_done = 0; |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1782 xg_get_file_func func; |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1783 |
58818
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1784 #if defined (HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD) && defined (__SIGRTMIN) |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1785 /* I really don't know why this is needed, but without this the GLIBC add on |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1786 library linuxthreads hangs when the Gnome file chooser backend creates |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1787 threads. */ |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1788 sigblock (sigmask (__SIGRTMIN)); |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1789 #endif /* HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD */ |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1790 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1791 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW |
58463
86fddd350b35
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_name): Rename use-old-gtk-file-dialog to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58284
diff
changeset
|
1792 |
67761
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1793 if (xg_uses_old_file_dialog ()) |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1794 w = xg_get_file_with_selection (f, prompt, default_filename, |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1795 mustmatch_p, only_dir_p, &func); |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1796 else |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1797 w = xg_get_file_with_chooser (f, prompt, default_filename, |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1798 mustmatch_p, only_dir_p, &func); |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1799 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1800 #else /* not HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW */ |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1801 w = xg_get_file_with_chooser (f, prompt, default_filename, |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1802 mustmatch_p, only_dir_p, &func); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1803 #endif /* not HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW */ |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1804 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1805 gtk_widget_set_name (w, "emacs-filedialog"); |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1806 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1807 filesel_done = xg_dialog_run (f, w); |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1808 |
58818
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1809 #if defined (HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD) && defined (__SIGRTMIN) |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1810 sigunblock (sigmask (__SIGRTMIN)); |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1811 #endif |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1812 |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1813 if (filesel_done == GTK_RESPONSE_OK) |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1814 fn = (*func) (w); |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1815 |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1816 gtk_widget_destroy (w); |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1817 return fn; |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1818 } |
49323 | 1819 |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1820 #ifdef HAVE_FREETYPE |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1821 /* Pop up a GTK font selector and return the name of the font the user |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1822 selects, as a C string. The returned font name follows GTK's own |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1823 format: |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1824 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1825 `FAMILY [VALUE1 VALUE2] SIZE' |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1826 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1827 This can be parsed using font_parse_fcname in font.c. |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1828 DEFAULT_NAME, if non-zero, is the default font name. */ |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1829 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1830 char * |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
1831 xg_get_font_name (FRAME_PTR f, const char *default_name) |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1832 { |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1833 GtkWidget *w; |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1834 char *fontname = NULL; |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1835 int done = 0; |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1836 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1837 #if defined (HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD) && defined (__SIGRTMIN) |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1838 sigblock (sigmask (__SIGRTMIN)); |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1839 #endif /* HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD */ |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1840 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1841 w = gtk_font_selection_dialog_new ("Pick a font"); |
105693
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
1842 if (!default_name) |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
1843 default_name = "Monospace 10"; |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
1844 gtk_font_selection_dialog_set_font_name (GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG (w), |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
1845 default_name); |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1846 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1847 gtk_widget_set_name (w, "emacs-fontdialog"); |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1848 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1849 done = xg_dialog_run (f, w); |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1850 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1851 #if defined (HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD) && defined (__SIGRTMIN) |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1852 sigunblock (sigmask (__SIGRTMIN)); |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1853 #endif |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1854 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1855 if (done == GTK_RESPONSE_OK) |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1856 fontname = gtk_font_selection_dialog_get_font_name |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1857 (GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG (w)); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1858 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1859 gtk_widget_destroy (w); |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1860 return fontname; |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1861 } |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1862 #endif /* HAVE_FREETYPE */ |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1863 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1864 |
49323 | 1865 |
1866 /*********************************************************************** | |
1867 Menu functions. | |
1868 ***********************************************************************/ | |
1869 | |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
1870 /* The name of menu items that can be used for customization. Since GTK |
49323 | 1871 RC files are very crude and primitive, we have to set this on all |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
1872 menu item names so a user can easily customize menu items. */ |
49323 | 1873 |
1874 #define MENU_ITEM_NAME "emacs-menuitem" | |
1875 | |
1876 | |
1877 /* Linked list of all allocated struct xg_menu_cb_data. Used for marking | |
1878 during GC. The next member points to the items. */ | |
1879 static xg_list_node xg_menu_cb_list; | |
1880 | |
1881 /* Linked list of all allocated struct xg_menu_item_cb_data. Used for marking | |
1882 during GC. The next member points to the items. */ | |
1883 static xg_list_node xg_menu_item_cb_list; | |
1884 | |
1885 /* Allocate and initialize CL_DATA if NULL, otherwise increase ref_count. | |
1886 F is the frame CL_DATA will be initialized for. | |
1887 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
1888 | |
1889 The menu bar and all sub menus under the menu bar in a frame | |
1890 share the same structure, hence the reference count. | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1891 |
49323 | 1892 Returns CL_DATA if CL_DATA is not NULL, or a pointer to a newly |
1893 allocated xg_menu_cb_data if CL_DATA is NULL. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1894 |
49323 | 1895 static xg_menu_cb_data * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1896 make_cl_data (xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data, FRAME_PTR f, GCallback highlight_cb) |
49323 | 1897 { |
1898 if (! cl_data) | |
1899 { | |
1900 cl_data = (xg_menu_cb_data*) xmalloc (sizeof (*cl_data)); | |
1901 cl_data->f = f; | |
1902 cl_data->menu_bar_vector = f->menu_bar_vector; | |
1903 cl_data->menu_bar_items_used = f->menu_bar_items_used; | |
1904 cl_data->highlight_cb = highlight_cb; | |
1905 cl_data->ref_count = 0; | |
1906 | |
1907 xg_list_insert (&xg_menu_cb_list, &cl_data->ptrs); | |
1908 } | |
1909 | |
1910 cl_data->ref_count++; | |
1911 | |
1912 return cl_data; | |
1913 } | |
1914 | |
1915 /* Update CL_DATA with values from frame F and with HIGHLIGHT_CB. | |
1916 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
1917 | |
1918 When the menu bar is updated, menu items may have been added and/or | |
1919 removed, so menu_bar_vector and menu_bar_items_used change. We must | |
1920 then update CL_DATA since it is used to determine which menu | |
1921 item that is invoked in the menu. | |
1922 HIGHLIGHT_CB could change, there is no check that the same | |
1923 function is given when modifying a menu bar as was given when | |
1924 creating the menu bar. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1925 |
49323 | 1926 static void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1927 update_cl_data (xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1928 FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1929 GCallback highlight_cb) |
49323 | 1930 { |
1931 if (cl_data) | |
1932 { | |
1933 cl_data->f = f; | |
1934 cl_data->menu_bar_vector = f->menu_bar_vector; | |
1935 cl_data->menu_bar_items_used = f->menu_bar_items_used; | |
1936 cl_data->highlight_cb = highlight_cb; | |
1937 } | |
1938 } | |
1939 | |
1940 /* Decrease reference count for CL_DATA. | |
1941 If reference count is zero, free CL_DATA. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1942 |
49323 | 1943 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1944 unref_cl_data (xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data) |
49323 | 1945 { |
1946 if (cl_data && cl_data->ref_count > 0) | |
1947 { | |
1948 cl_data->ref_count--; | |
1949 if (cl_data->ref_count == 0) | |
1950 { | |
1951 xg_list_remove (&xg_menu_cb_list, &cl_data->ptrs); | |
1952 xfree (cl_data); | |
1953 } | |
1954 } | |
1955 } | |
1956 | |
1957 /* Function that marks all lisp data during GC. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1958 |
49323 | 1959 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1960 xg_mark_data (void) |
49323 | 1961 { |
1962 xg_list_node *iter; | |
1963 | |
1964 for (iter = xg_menu_cb_list.next; iter; iter = iter->next) | |
52080
c150d4a7aa36
gtkutil.c (xg_mark_data): Update calls to mark_object.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51569
diff
changeset
|
1965 mark_object (((xg_menu_cb_data *) iter)->menu_bar_vector); |
49323 | 1966 |
1967 for (iter = xg_menu_item_cb_list.next; iter; iter = iter->next) | |
1968 { | |
1969 xg_menu_item_cb_data *cb_data = (xg_menu_item_cb_data *) iter; | |
1970 | |
1971 if (! NILP (cb_data->help)) | |
52080
c150d4a7aa36
gtkutil.c (xg_mark_data): Update calls to mark_object.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51569
diff
changeset
|
1972 mark_object (cb_data->help); |
49323 | 1973 } |
1974 } | |
1975 | |
1976 | |
1977 /* Callback called when a menu item is destroyed. Used to free data. | |
1978 W is the widget that is being destroyed (not used). | |
1979 CLIENT_DATA points to the xg_menu_item_cb_data associated with the W. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1980 |
49323 | 1981 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1982 menuitem_destroy_callback (GtkWidget *w, gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 1983 { |
1984 if (client_data) | |
1985 { | |
1986 xg_menu_item_cb_data *data = (xg_menu_item_cb_data*) client_data; | |
1987 xg_list_remove (&xg_menu_item_cb_list, &data->ptrs); | |
1988 xfree (data); | |
1989 } | |
1990 } | |
1991 | |
1992 /* Callback called when the pointer enters/leaves a menu item. | |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
1993 W is the parent of the menu item. |
49323 | 1994 EVENT is either an enter event or leave event. |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
1995 CLIENT_DATA is not used. |
49323 | 1996 |
1997 Returns FALSE to tell GTK to keep processing this event. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1998 |
49323 | 1999 static gboolean |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2000 menuitem_highlight_callback (GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2001 GdkEventCrossing *event, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2002 gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 2003 { |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2004 GdkEvent ev; |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2005 GtkWidget *subwidget; |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2006 xg_menu_item_cb_data *data; |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2007 |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2008 ev.crossing = *event; |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2009 subwidget = gtk_get_event_widget (&ev); |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2010 data = (xg_menu_item_cb_data *) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (subwidget), |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2011 XG_ITEM_DATA); |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2012 if (data) |
49323 | 2013 { |
2014 if (! NILP (data->help) && data->cl_data->highlight_cb) | |
2015 { | |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2016 gpointer call_data = event->type == GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY ? 0 : data; |
49323 | 2017 GtkCallback func = (GtkCallback) data->cl_data->highlight_cb; |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2018 (*func) (subwidget, call_data); |
49323 | 2019 } |
2020 } | |
2021 | |
2022 return FALSE; | |
2023 } | |
2024 | |
2025 /* Callback called when a menu is destroyed. Used to free data. | |
2026 W is the widget that is being destroyed (not used). | |
2027 CLIENT_DATA points to the xg_menu_cb_data associated with W. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2028 |
49323 | 2029 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2030 menu_destroy_callback (GtkWidget *w, gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 2031 { |
2032 unref_cl_data ((xg_menu_cb_data*) client_data); | |
2033 } | |
2034 | |
2035 /* Make a GTK widget that contains both UTF8_LABEL and UTF8_KEY (both | |
2036 must be non-NULL) and can be inserted into a menu item. | |
2037 | |
2038 Returns the GtkHBox. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2039 |
49323 | 2040 static GtkWidget * |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
2041 make_widget_for_menu_item (const char *utf8_label, const char *utf8_key) |
49323 | 2042 { |
2043 GtkWidget *wlbl; | |
2044 GtkWidget *wkey; | |
2045 GtkWidget *wbox; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2046 |
49323 | 2047 wbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2048 wlbl = gtk_label_new (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2049 wkey = gtk_label_new (utf8_key); |
2050 | |
2051 gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (wlbl), 0.0, 0.5); | |
2052 gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (wkey), 0.0, 0.5); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2053 |
49323 | 2054 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wbox), wlbl, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
2055 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wbox), wkey, FALSE, FALSE, 0); | |
2056 | |
2057 gtk_widget_set_name (wlbl, MENU_ITEM_NAME); | |
2058 gtk_widget_set_name (wkey, MENU_ITEM_NAME); | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
2059 gtk_widget_set_name (wbox, MENU_ITEM_NAME); |
49323 | 2060 |
2061 return wbox; | |
2062 } | |
2063 | |
2064 /* Make and return a menu item widget with the key to the right. | |
2065 UTF8_LABEL is the text for the menu item (GTK uses UTF8 internally). | |
2066 UTF8_KEY is the text representing the key binding. | |
2067 ITEM is the widget_value describing the menu item. | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2068 |
49323 | 2069 GROUP is an in/out parameter. If the menu item to be created is not |
2070 part of any radio menu group, *GROUP contains NULL on entry and exit. | |
2071 If the menu item to be created is part of a radio menu group, on entry | |
2072 *GROUP contains the group to use, or NULL if this is the first item | |
2073 in the group. On exit, *GROUP contains the radio item group. | |
2074 | |
2075 Unfortunately, keys don't line up as nicely as in Motif, | |
2076 but the MacOS X version doesn't either, so I guess that is OK. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2077 |
49323 | 2078 static GtkWidget * |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
2079 make_menu_item (const char *utf8_label, |
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
2080 const char *utf8_key, |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2081 widget_value *item, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2082 GSList **group) |
49323 | 2083 { |
2084 GtkWidget *w; | |
2085 GtkWidget *wtoadd = 0; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2086 |
51432
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2087 /* It has been observed that some menu items have a NULL name field. |
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2088 This will lead to this function being called with a NULL utf8_label. |
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2089 GTK crashes on that so we set a blank label. Why there is a NULL |
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2090 name remains to be investigated. */ |
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2091 if (! utf8_label) utf8_label = " "; |
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2092 |
49323 | 2093 if (utf8_key) |
2094 wtoadd = make_widget_for_menu_item (utf8_label, utf8_key); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2095 |
49323 | 2096 if (item->button_type == BUTTON_TYPE_TOGGLE) |
2097 { | |
2098 *group = NULL; | |
2099 if (utf8_key) w = gtk_check_menu_item_new (); | |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2100 else w = gtk_check_menu_item_new_with_label (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2101 gtk_check_menu_item_set_active (GTK_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (w), item->selected); |
2102 } | |
2103 else if (item->button_type == BUTTON_TYPE_RADIO) | |
2104 { | |
2105 if (utf8_key) w = gtk_radio_menu_item_new (*group); | |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2106 else w = gtk_radio_menu_item_new_with_label (*group, utf8_label); |
49323 | 2107 *group = gtk_radio_menu_item_get_group (GTK_RADIO_MENU_ITEM (w)); |
2108 if (item->selected) | |
2109 gtk_check_menu_item_set_active (GTK_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (w), TRUE); | |
2110 } | |
2111 else | |
2112 { | |
2113 *group = NULL; | |
2114 if (utf8_key) w = gtk_menu_item_new (); | |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2115 else w = gtk_menu_item_new_with_label (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2116 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2117 |
49323 | 2118 if (wtoadd) gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (w), wtoadd); |
2119 if (! item->enabled) gtk_widget_set_sensitive (w, FALSE); | |
2120 | |
2121 return w; | |
2122 } | |
2123 | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2124 static int xg_detached_menus; |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2125 |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2126 /* Returns non-zero if there are detached menus. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2127 |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2128 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2129 xg_have_tear_offs (void) |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2130 { |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2131 return xg_detached_menus > 0; |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2132 } |
49323 | 2133 |
2134 /* Callback invoked when a detached menu window is removed. Here we | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2135 decrease the xg_detached_menus count. |
49323 | 2136 WIDGET is the top level window that is removed (the parent of the menu). |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2137 CLIENT_DATA is not used. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2138 |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2139 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2140 tearoff_remove (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 2141 { |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2142 if (xg_detached_menus > 0) --xg_detached_menus; |
49323 | 2143 } |
2144 | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2145 /* Callback invoked when a menu is detached. It increases the |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2146 xg_detached_menus count. |
49323 | 2147 WIDGET is the GtkTearoffMenuItem. |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2148 CLIENT_DATA is not used. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2149 |
49323 | 2150 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2151 tearoff_activate (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 2152 { |
2153 GtkWidget *menu = gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2154 if (gtk_menu_get_tearoff_state (GTK_MENU (menu))) |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2155 { |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2156 ++xg_detached_menus; |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2157 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget)), |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2158 "destroy", |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2159 G_CALLBACK (tearoff_remove), 0); |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2160 } |
49323 | 2161 } |
2162 | |
2163 | |
2164 /* Create a menu item widget, and connect the callbacks. | |
2165 ITEM decribes the menu item. | |
2166 F is the frame the created menu belongs to. | |
2167 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2168 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
2169 CL_DATA points to the callback data to be used for this menu. | |
2170 GROUP is an in/out parameter. If the menu item to be created is not | |
2171 part of any radio menu group, *GROUP contains NULL on entry and exit. | |
2172 If the menu item to be created is part of a radio menu group, on entry | |
2173 *GROUP contains the group to use, or NULL if this is the first item | |
2174 in the group. On exit, *GROUP contains the radio item group. | |
2175 | |
2176 Returns the created GtkWidget. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2177 |
49323 | 2178 static GtkWidget * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2179 xg_create_one_menuitem (widget_value *item, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2180 FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2181 GCallback select_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2182 GCallback highlight_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2183 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2184 GSList **group) |
49323 | 2185 { |
2186 char *utf8_label; | |
2187 char *utf8_key; | |
2188 GtkWidget *w; | |
2189 xg_menu_item_cb_data *cb_data; | |
2190 | |
2191 utf8_label = get_utf8_string (item->name); | |
2192 utf8_key = get_utf8_string (item->key); | |
2193 | |
2194 w = make_menu_item (utf8_label, utf8_key, item, group); | |
2195 | |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2196 if (utf8_label) g_free (utf8_label); |
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2197 if (utf8_key) g_free (utf8_key); |
49323 | 2198 |
2199 cb_data = xmalloc (sizeof (xg_menu_item_cb_data)); | |
2200 | |
2201 xg_list_insert (&xg_menu_item_cb_list, &cb_data->ptrs); | |
2202 | |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2203 cb_data->select_id = 0; |
49323 | 2204 cb_data->help = item->help; |
2205 cb_data->cl_data = cl_data; | |
2206 cb_data->call_data = item->call_data; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2207 |
49323 | 2208 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), |
2209 "destroy", | |
2210 G_CALLBACK (menuitem_destroy_callback), | |
2211 cb_data); | |
2212 | |
2213 /* Put cb_data in widget, so we can get at it when modifying menubar */ | |
2214 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (w), XG_ITEM_DATA, cb_data); | |
2215 | |
2216 /* final item, not a submenu */ | |
2217 if (item->call_data && ! item->contents) | |
2218 { | |
2219 if (select_cb) | |
2220 cb_data->select_id | |
2221 = g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), "activate", select_cb, cb_data); | |
2222 } | |
2223 | |
2224 return w; | |
2225 } | |
2226 | |
2227 /* Create a full menu tree specified by DATA. | |
2228 F is the frame the created menu belongs to. | |
2229 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2230 DEACTIVATE_CB is the callback to use when a sub menu is not shown anymore. | |
2231 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
2232 POP_UP_P is non-zero if we shall create a popup menu. | |
2233 MENU_BAR_P is non-zero if we shall create a menu bar. | |
2234 ADD_TEAROFF_P is non-zero if we shall add a teroff menu item. Ignored | |
2235 if MENU_BAR_P is non-zero. | |
2236 TOPMENU is the topmost GtkWidget that others shall be placed under. | |
2237 It may be NULL, in that case we create the appropriate widget | |
2238 (menu bar or menu item depending on POP_UP_P and MENU_BAR_P) | |
2239 CL_DATA is the callback data we shall use for this menu, or NULL | |
2240 if we haven't set the first callback yet. | |
2241 NAME is the name to give to the top level menu if this function | |
2242 creates it. May be NULL to not set any name. | |
2243 | |
2244 Returns the top level GtkWidget. This is TOPLEVEL if TOPLEVEL is | |
2245 not NULL. | |
2246 | |
2247 This function calls itself to create submenus. */ | |
2248 | |
2249 static GtkWidget * | |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2250 create_menus (widget_value *data, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2251 FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2252 GCallback select_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2253 GCallback deactivate_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2254 GCallback highlight_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2255 int pop_up_p, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2256 int menu_bar_p, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2257 int add_tearoff_p, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2258 GtkWidget *topmenu, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2259 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data, |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
2260 const char *name) |
49323 | 2261 { |
2262 widget_value *item; | |
2263 GtkWidget *wmenu = topmenu; | |
2264 GSList *group = NULL; | |
2265 | |
2266 if (! topmenu) | |
2267 { | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2268 if (! menu_bar_p) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2269 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2270 wmenu = gtk_menu_new (); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2271 xg_set_screen (wmenu, f); |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2272 /* Connect this to the menu instead of items so we get enter/leave for |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2273 disabled items also. TODO: Still does not get enter/leave for |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2274 disabled items in detached menus. */ |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2275 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenu), |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2276 "enter-notify-event", |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2277 G_CALLBACK (menuitem_highlight_callback), |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2278 NULL); |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2279 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenu), |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2280 "leave-notify-event", |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2281 G_CALLBACK (menuitem_highlight_callback), |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2282 NULL); |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2283 } |
105522
695dbf5b3bb9
gtkutil.c (create_menus): Call gtk_widget_set_size_request for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103916
diff
changeset
|
2284 else |
695dbf5b3bb9
gtkutil.c (create_menus): Call gtk_widget_set_size_request for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103916
diff
changeset
|
2285 { |
695dbf5b3bb9
gtkutil.c (create_menus): Call gtk_widget_set_size_request for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103916
diff
changeset
|
2286 wmenu = gtk_menu_bar_new (); |
106186
9b6f45dd8386
Use a select wrapper around the GLib event loop, thus taking into account GLib
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106161
diff
changeset
|
2287 /* Set width of menu bar to a small value so it doesn't enlarge |
9b6f45dd8386
Use a select wrapper around the GLib event loop, thus taking into account GLib
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106161
diff
changeset
|
2288 a small initial frame size. The width will be set to the |
9b6f45dd8386
Use a select wrapper around the GLib event loop, thus taking into account GLib
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106161
diff
changeset
|
2289 width of the frame later on when it is added to a container. |
9b6f45dd8386
Use a select wrapper around the GLib event loop, thus taking into account GLib
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106161
diff
changeset
|
2290 height -1: Natural height. */ |
105522
695dbf5b3bb9
gtkutil.c (create_menus): Call gtk_widget_set_size_request for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103916
diff
changeset
|
2291 gtk_widget_set_size_request (wmenu, 1, -1); |
695dbf5b3bb9
gtkutil.c (create_menus): Call gtk_widget_set_size_request for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103916
diff
changeset
|
2292 } |
49323 | 2293 |
2294 /* Put cl_data on the top menu for easier access. */ | |
2295 cl_data = make_cl_data (cl_data, f, highlight_cb); | |
2296 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wmenu), XG_FRAME_DATA, (gpointer)cl_data); | |
2297 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenu), "destroy", | |
2298 G_CALLBACK (menu_destroy_callback), cl_data); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2299 |
49323 | 2300 if (name) |
2301 gtk_widget_set_name (wmenu, name); | |
2302 | |
2303 if (deactivate_cb) | |
2304 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenu), | |
59913
b3664fca53d1
* gtkutil.c (create_menus): Connect selection-done event instead of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59666
diff
changeset
|
2305 "selection-done", deactivate_cb, 0); |
49323 | 2306 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2307 |
49323 | 2308 if (! menu_bar_p && add_tearoff_p) |
2309 { | |
2310 GtkWidget *tearoff = gtk_tearoff_menu_item_new (); | |
2311 gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (wmenu), tearoff); | |
2312 | |
2313 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (tearoff), "activate", | |
2314 G_CALLBACK (tearoff_activate), 0); | |
2315 } | |
2316 | |
2317 for (item = data; item; item = item->next) | |
2318 { | |
2319 GtkWidget *w; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2320 |
49323 | 2321 if (pop_up_p && !item->contents && !item->call_data |
111991
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
2322 && !menu_separator_name_p (item->name)) |
49323 | 2323 { |
2324 char *utf8_label; | |
2325 /* A title for a popup. We do the same as GTK does when | |
2326 creating titles, but it does not look good. */ | |
2327 group = NULL; | |
2328 utf8_label = get_utf8_string (item->name); | |
2329 | |
2330 gtk_menu_set_title (GTK_MENU (wmenu), utf8_label); | |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2331 w = gtk_menu_item_new_with_label (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2332 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (w, FALSE); |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2333 if (utf8_label) g_free (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2334 } |
111991
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
2335 else if (menu_separator_name_p (item->name)) |
49323 | 2336 { |
2337 group = NULL; | |
2338 /* GTK only have one separator type. */ | |
2339 w = gtk_separator_menu_item_new (); | |
2340 } | |
2341 else | |
2342 { | |
2343 w = xg_create_one_menuitem (item, | |
2344 f, | |
2345 item->contents ? 0 : select_cb, | |
2346 highlight_cb, | |
2347 cl_data, | |
2348 &group); | |
2349 | |
77511
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2350 /* Create a possibly empty submenu for menu bar items, since some |
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2351 themes don't highlight items correctly without it. */ |
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2352 if (item->contents || menu_bar_p) |
49323 | 2353 { |
2354 GtkWidget *submenu = create_menus (item->contents, | |
2355 f, | |
2356 select_cb, | |
2357 deactivate_cb, | |
2358 highlight_cb, | |
2359 0, | |
2360 0, | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2361 add_tearoff_p, |
49323 | 2362 0, |
2363 cl_data, | |
2364 0); | |
2365 gtk_menu_item_set_submenu (GTK_MENU_ITEM (w), submenu); | |
2366 } | |
2367 } | |
2368 | |
2369 gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (wmenu), w); | |
2370 gtk_widget_set_name (w, MENU_ITEM_NAME); | |
2371 } | |
2372 | |
2373 return wmenu; | |
2374 } | |
2375 | |
2376 /* Create a menubar, popup menu or dialog, depending on the TYPE argument. | |
2377 TYPE can be "menubar", "popup" for popup menu, or "dialog" for a dialog | |
2378 with some text and buttons. | |
2379 F is the frame the created item belongs to. | |
2380 NAME is the name to use for the top widget. | |
2381 VAL is a widget_value structure describing items to be created. | |
2382 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected or | |
2383 a dialog button is pressed. | |
2384 DEACTIVATE_CB is the callback to use when an item is deactivated. | |
2385 For a menu, when a sub menu is not shown anymore, for a dialog it is | |
2386 called when the dialog is popped down. | |
2387 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
2388 | |
2389 Returns the widget created. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2390 |
49323 | 2391 GtkWidget * |
109717
8949aad5e992
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109668
diff
changeset
|
2392 xg_create_widget (const char *type, const char *name, FRAME_PTR f, widget_value *val, |
109364
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
2393 GCallback select_cb, GCallback deactivate_cb, |
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
2394 GCallback highlight_cb) |
49323 | 2395 { |
2396 GtkWidget *w = 0; | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2397 int menu_bar_p = strcmp (type, "menubar") == 0; |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2398 int pop_up_p = strcmp (type, "popup") == 0; |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2399 |
49323 | 2400 if (strcmp (type, "dialog") == 0) |
2401 { | |
2402 w = create_dialog (val, select_cb, deactivate_cb); | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2403 xg_set_screen (w, f); |
49323 | 2404 gtk_window_set_transient_for (GTK_WINDOW (w), |
2405 GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))); | |
2406 gtk_window_set_destroy_with_parent (GTK_WINDOW (w), TRUE); | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2407 gtk_widget_set_name (w, "emacs-dialog"); |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
2408 gtk_window_set_modal (GTK_WINDOW (w), TRUE); |
49323 | 2409 } |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2410 else if (menu_bar_p || pop_up_p) |
49323 | 2411 { |
2412 w = create_menus (val->contents, | |
2413 f, | |
2414 select_cb, | |
2415 deactivate_cb, | |
2416 highlight_cb, | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2417 pop_up_p, |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2418 menu_bar_p, |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2419 menu_bar_p, |
49323 | 2420 0, |
2421 0, | |
2422 name); | |
2423 | |
2424 /* Set the cursor to an arrow for popup menus when they are mapped. | |
2425 This is done by default for menu bar menus. */ | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2426 if (pop_up_p) |
49323 | 2427 { |
2428 /* Must realize so the GdkWindow inside the widget is created. */ | |
2429 gtk_widget_realize (w); | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2430 xg_set_cursor (w, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->xg_cursor); |
49323 | 2431 } |
2432 } | |
2433 else | |
2434 { | |
2435 fprintf (stderr, "bad type in xg_create_widget: %s, doing nothing\n", | |
2436 type); | |
2437 } | |
2438 | |
2439 return w; | |
2440 } | |
2441 | |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2442 /* Return the label for menu item WITEM. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2443 |
49323 | 2444 static const char * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2445 xg_get_menu_item_label (GtkMenuItem *witem) |
49323 | 2446 { |
111991
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
2447 GtkLabel *wlabel = GTK_LABEL (XG_BIN_CHILD (witem)); |
49323 | 2448 return gtk_label_get_label (wlabel); |
2449 } | |
2450 | |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2451 /* Return non-zero if the menu item WITEM has the text LABEL. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2452 |
49323 | 2453 static int |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2454 xg_item_label_same_p (GtkMenuItem *witem, const char *label) |
49323 | 2455 { |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2456 int is_same = 0; |
49323 | 2457 char *utf8_label = get_utf8_string (label); |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2458 const char *old_label = witem ? xg_get_menu_item_label (witem) : 0; |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2459 |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2460 if (! old_label && ! utf8_label) |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2461 is_same = 1; |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2462 else if (old_label && utf8_label) |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2463 is_same = strcmp (utf8_label, old_label) == 0; |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2464 |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2465 if (utf8_label) g_free (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2466 |
2467 return is_same; | |
2468 } | |
2469 | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2470 /* Destroy widgets in LIST. */ |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2471 |
49323 | 2472 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2473 xg_destroy_widgets (GList *list) |
49323 | 2474 { |
2475 GList *iter; | |
2476 | |
49572 | 2477 for (iter = list; iter; iter = g_list_next (iter)) |
49323 | 2478 { |
2479 GtkWidget *w = GTK_WIDGET (iter->data); | |
2480 | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2481 /* Destroying the widget will remove it from the container it is in. */ |
49323 | 2482 gtk_widget_destroy (w); |
2483 } | |
2484 } | |
2485 | |
2486 /* Update the top level names in MENUBAR (i.e. not submenus). | |
2487 F is the frame the menu bar belongs to. | |
49572 | 2488 *LIST is a list with the current menu bar names (menu item widgets). |
2489 ITER is the item within *LIST that shall be updated. | |
2490 POS is the numerical position, starting at 0, of ITER in *LIST. | |
49323 | 2491 VAL describes what the menu bar shall look like after the update. |
2492 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2493 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
49572 | 2494 CL_DATA points to the callback data to be used for this menu bar. |
49323 | 2495 |
2496 This function calls itself to walk through the menu bar names. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2497 |
49323 | 2498 static void |
109139
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2499 xg_update_menubar (GtkWidget *menubar, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2500 FRAME_PTR f, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2501 GList **list, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2502 GList *iter, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2503 int pos, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2504 widget_value *val, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2505 GCallback select_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2506 GCallback deactivate_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2507 GCallback highlight_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2508 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data) |
49323 | 2509 { |
49572 | 2510 if (! iter && ! val) |
49323 | 2511 return; |
49572 | 2512 else if (iter && ! val) |
49323 | 2513 { |
49572 | 2514 /* Item(s) have been removed. Remove all remaining items. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2515 xg_destroy_widgets (iter); |
49323 | 2516 |
106161
0ea716305b13
gtkutil.c (xg_modify_menubar_widgets): If menubar is totally empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106012
diff
changeset
|
2517 /* Add a blank entry so the menubar doesn't collapse to nothing. */ |
0ea716305b13
gtkutil.c (xg_modify_menubar_widgets): If menubar is totally empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106012
diff
changeset
|
2518 gtk_menu_shell_insert (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menubar), |
0ea716305b13
gtkutil.c (xg_modify_menubar_widgets): If menubar is totally empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106012
diff
changeset
|
2519 gtk_menu_item_new_with_label (""), |
0ea716305b13
gtkutil.c (xg_modify_menubar_widgets): If menubar is totally empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106012
diff
changeset
|
2520 0); |
49323 | 2521 /* All updated. */ |
2522 val = 0; | |
49572 | 2523 iter = 0; |
49323 | 2524 } |
49572 | 2525 else if (! iter && val) |
49323 | 2526 { |
2527 /* Item(s) added. Add all new items in one call. */ | |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
2528 create_menus (val, f, select_cb, deactivate_cb, highlight_cb, |
49323 | 2529 0, 1, 0, menubar, cl_data, 0); |
2530 | |
2531 /* All updated. */ | |
2532 val = 0; | |
49572 | 2533 iter = 0; |
49323 | 2534 } |
49572 | 2535 /* Below this neither iter or val is NULL */ |
2536 else if (xg_item_label_same_p (GTK_MENU_ITEM (iter->data), val->name)) | |
49323 | 2537 { |
2538 /* This item is still the same, check next item. */ | |
2539 val = val->next; | |
49572 | 2540 iter = g_list_next (iter); |
2541 ++pos; | |
49323 | 2542 } |
2543 else /* This item is changed. */ | |
2544 { | |
49572 | 2545 GtkMenuItem *witem = GTK_MENU_ITEM (iter->data); |
49323 | 2546 GtkMenuItem *witem2 = 0; |
2547 int val_in_menubar = 0; | |
49572 | 2548 int iter_in_new_menubar = 0; |
2549 GList *iter2; | |
49323 | 2550 widget_value *cur; |
2551 | |
2552 /* See if the changed entry (val) is present later in the menu bar */ | |
49572 | 2553 for (iter2 = iter; |
2554 iter2 && ! val_in_menubar; | |
2555 iter2 = g_list_next (iter2)) | |
49323 | 2556 { |
49572 | 2557 witem2 = GTK_MENU_ITEM (iter2->data); |
49323 | 2558 val_in_menubar = xg_item_label_same_p (witem2, val->name); |
2559 } | |
2560 | |
49572 | 2561 /* See if the current entry (iter) is present later in the |
49323 | 2562 specification for the new menu bar. */ |
49572 | 2563 for (cur = val; cur && ! iter_in_new_menubar; cur = cur->next) |
2564 iter_in_new_menubar = xg_item_label_same_p (witem, cur->name); | |
2565 | |
2566 if (val_in_menubar && ! iter_in_new_menubar) | |
49323 | 2567 { |
49572 | 2568 int nr = pos; |
2569 | |
49323 | 2570 /* This corresponds to: |
2571 Current: A B C | |
2572 New: A C | |
2573 Remove B. */ | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2574 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2575 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (witem)); |
49323 | 2576 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar), GTK_WIDGET (witem)); |
2577 gtk_widget_destroy (GTK_WIDGET (witem)); | |
2578 | |
2579 /* Must get new list since the old changed. */ | |
49572 | 2580 g_list_free (*list); |
2581 *list = iter = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar)); | |
2582 while (nr-- > 0) iter = g_list_next (iter); | |
49323 | 2583 } |
49572 | 2584 else if (! val_in_menubar && ! iter_in_new_menubar) |
49323 | 2585 { |
2586 /* This corresponds to: | |
2587 Current: A B C | |
2588 New: A X C | |
2589 Rename B to X. This might seem to be a strange thing to do, | |
2590 since if there is a menu under B it will be totally wrong for X. | |
2591 But consider editing a C file. Then there is a C-mode menu | |
2592 (corresponds to B above). | |
2593 If then doing C-x C-f the minibuf menu (X above) replaces the | |
2594 C-mode menu. When returning from the minibuffer, we get | |
2595 back the C-mode menu. Thus we do: | |
2596 Rename B to X (C-mode to minibuf menu) | |
2597 Rename X to B (minibuf to C-mode menu). | |
2598 If the X menu hasn't been invoked, the menu under B | |
2599 is up to date when leaving the minibuffer. */ | |
111991
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
2600 GtkLabel *wlabel = GTK_LABEL (XG_BIN_CHILD (witem)); |
49323 | 2601 char *utf8_label = get_utf8_string (val->name); |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2602 GtkWidget *submenu = gtk_menu_item_get_submenu (witem); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2603 |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2604 gtk_label_set_text (wlabel, utf8_label); |
49323 | 2605 |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2606 /* If this item has a submenu that has been detached, change |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2607 the title in the WM decorations also. */ |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2608 if (submenu && gtk_menu_get_tearoff_state (GTK_MENU (submenu))) |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2609 /* Set the title of the detached window. */ |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2610 gtk_menu_set_title (GTK_MENU (submenu), utf8_label); |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2611 |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2612 if (utf8_label) g_free (utf8_label); |
49572 | 2613 iter = g_list_next (iter); |
49323 | 2614 val = val->next; |
49572 | 2615 ++pos; |
49323 | 2616 } |
49572 | 2617 else if (! val_in_menubar && iter_in_new_menubar) |
49323 | 2618 { |
2619 /* This corresponds to: | |
2620 Current: A B C | |
2621 New: A X B C | |
2622 Insert X. */ | |
2623 | |
49572 | 2624 int nr = pos; |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2625 GSList *group = 0; |
49323 | 2626 GtkWidget *w = xg_create_one_menuitem (val, |
2627 f, | |
2628 select_cb, | |
2629 highlight_cb, | |
2630 cl_data, | |
2631 &group); | |
2632 | |
77511
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2633 /* Create a possibly empty submenu for menu bar items, since some |
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2634 themes don't highlight items correctly without it. */ |
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2635 GtkWidget *submenu = create_menus (NULL, f, |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
2636 select_cb, deactivate_cb, |
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
2637 highlight_cb, |
77511
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2638 0, 0, 0, 0, cl_data, 0); |
49323 | 2639 gtk_widget_set_name (w, MENU_ITEM_NAME); |
2640 gtk_menu_shell_insert (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menubar), w, pos); | |
77511
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2641 gtk_menu_item_set_submenu (GTK_MENU_ITEM (w), submenu); |
49323 | 2642 |
49572 | 2643 g_list_free (*list); |
2644 *list = iter = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar)); | |
2645 while (nr-- > 0) iter = g_list_next (iter); | |
2646 iter = g_list_next (iter); | |
49323 | 2647 val = val->next; |
49572 | 2648 ++pos; |
49323 | 2649 } |
49572 | 2650 else /* if (val_in_menubar && iter_in_new_menubar) */ |
49323 | 2651 { |
49572 | 2652 int nr = pos; |
49323 | 2653 /* This corresponds to: |
2654 Current: A B C | |
2655 New: A C B | |
2656 Move C before B */ | |
2657 | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2658 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (witem2)); |
49323 | 2659 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar), GTK_WIDGET (witem2)); |
2660 gtk_menu_shell_insert (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menubar), | |
2661 GTK_WIDGET (witem2), pos); | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2662 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (witem2)); |
49323 | 2663 |
49572 | 2664 g_list_free (*list); |
2665 *list = iter = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar)); | |
2666 while (nr-- > 0) iter = g_list_next (iter); | |
76906
bb6e75c27940
(xg_update_menubar): Call g_list_next after moving
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75576
diff
changeset
|
2667 if (iter) iter = g_list_next (iter); |
49323 | 2668 val = val->next; |
49572 | 2669 ++pos; |
49323 | 2670 } |
2671 } | |
2672 | |
2673 /* Update the rest of the menu bar. */ | |
49572 | 2674 xg_update_menubar (menubar, f, list, iter, pos, val, |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
2675 select_cb, deactivate_cb, highlight_cb, cl_data); |
49323 | 2676 } |
2677 | |
2678 /* Update the menu item W so it corresponds to VAL. | |
2679 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2680 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
102358 | 2681 CL_DATA is the data to set in the widget for menu invocation. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2682 |
49323 | 2683 static void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2684 xg_update_menu_item (widget_value *val, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2685 GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2686 GCallback select_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2687 GCallback highlight_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2688 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data) |
49323 | 2689 { |
2690 GtkWidget *wchild; | |
2691 GtkLabel *wlbl = 0; | |
2692 GtkLabel *wkey = 0; | |
2693 char *utf8_label; | |
2694 char *utf8_key; | |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2695 const char *old_label = 0; |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2696 const char *old_key = 0; |
49323 | 2697 xg_menu_item_cb_data *cb_data; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2698 |
111991
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
2699 wchild = XG_BIN_CHILD (w); |
49323 | 2700 utf8_label = get_utf8_string (val->name); |
2701 utf8_key = get_utf8_string (val->key); | |
2702 | |
2703 /* See if W is a menu item with a key. See make_menu_item above. */ | |
2704 if (GTK_IS_HBOX (wchild)) | |
2705 { | |
2706 GList *list = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (wchild)); | |
2707 | |
2708 wlbl = GTK_LABEL (list->data); | |
2709 wkey = GTK_LABEL (list->next->data); | |
49572 | 2710 g_list_free (list); |
2711 | |
49323 | 2712 if (! utf8_key) |
2713 { | |
2714 /* Remove the key and keep just the label. */ | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2715 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (wlbl)); |
49323 | 2716 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (w), wchild); |
2717 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (w), GTK_WIDGET (wlbl)); | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2718 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (wlbl)); |
49323 | 2719 wkey = 0; |
2720 } | |
49572 | 2721 |
49323 | 2722 } |
2723 else /* Just a label. */ | |
2724 { | |
2725 wlbl = GTK_LABEL (wchild); | |
2726 | |
2727 /* Check if there is now a key. */ | |
2728 if (utf8_key) | |
2729 { | |
2730 GtkWidget *wtoadd = make_widget_for_menu_item (utf8_label, utf8_key); | |
2731 GList *list = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (wtoadd)); | |
49572 | 2732 |
49323 | 2733 wlbl = GTK_LABEL (list->data); |
2734 wkey = GTK_LABEL (list->next->data); | |
49572 | 2735 g_list_free (list); |
49323 | 2736 |
2737 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (w), wchild); | |
2738 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (w), wtoadd); | |
2739 } | |
2740 } | |
2741 | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2742 |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2743 if (wkey) old_key = gtk_label_get_label (wkey); |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2744 if (wlbl) old_label = gtk_label_get_label (wlbl); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2745 |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2746 if (wkey && utf8_key && (! old_key || strcmp (utf8_key, old_key) != 0)) |
49323 | 2747 gtk_label_set_text (wkey, utf8_key); |
2748 | |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2749 if (! old_label || strcmp (utf8_label, old_label) != 0) |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2750 gtk_label_set_text (wlbl, utf8_label); |
49323 | 2751 |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2752 if (utf8_key) g_free (utf8_key); |
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2753 if (utf8_label) g_free (utf8_label); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2754 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2755 if (! val->enabled && gtk_widget_get_sensitive (w)) |
49323 | 2756 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (w, FALSE); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2757 else if (val->enabled && ! gtk_widget_get_sensitive (w)) |
49323 | 2758 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (w, TRUE); |
2759 | |
2760 cb_data = (xg_menu_item_cb_data*) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), | |
2761 XG_ITEM_DATA); | |
2762 if (cb_data) | |
2763 { | |
2764 cb_data->call_data = val->call_data; | |
2765 cb_data->help = val->help; | |
2766 cb_data->cl_data = cl_data; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2767 |
49323 | 2768 /* We assume the callback functions don't change. */ |
2769 if (val->call_data && ! val->contents) | |
2770 { | |
2771 /* This item shall have a select callback. */ | |
2772 if (! cb_data->select_id) | |
2773 cb_data->select_id | |
2774 = g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), "activate", | |
2775 select_cb, cb_data); | |
2776 } | |
2777 else if (cb_data->select_id) | |
2778 { | |
2779 g_signal_handler_disconnect (w, cb_data->select_id); | |
2780 cb_data->select_id = 0; | |
2781 } | |
2782 } | |
2783 } | |
2784 | |
2785 /* Update the toggle menu item W so it corresponds to VAL. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2786 |
49323 | 2787 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2788 xg_update_toggle_item (widget_value *val, GtkWidget *w) |
49323 | 2789 { |
2790 gtk_check_menu_item_set_active (GTK_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (w), val->selected); | |
2791 } | |
2792 | |
2793 /* Update the radio menu item W so it corresponds to VAL. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2794 |
49323 | 2795 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2796 xg_update_radio_item (widget_value *val, GtkWidget *w) |
49323 | 2797 { |
2798 gtk_check_menu_item_set_active (GTK_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (w), val->selected); | |
2799 } | |
2800 | |
2801 /* Update the sub menu SUBMENU and all its children so it corresponds to VAL. | |
2802 SUBMENU may be NULL, in that case a new menu is created. | |
2803 F is the frame the menu bar belongs to. | |
2804 VAL describes the contents of the menu bar. | |
2805 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2806 DEACTIVATE_CB is the callback to use when a sub menu is not shown anymore. | |
2807 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
2808 CL_DATA is the call back data to use for any newly created items. | |
2809 | |
2810 Returns the updated submenu widget, that is SUBMENU unless SUBMENU | |
2811 was NULL. */ | |
2812 | |
2813 static GtkWidget * | |
109139
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2814 xg_update_submenu (GtkWidget *submenu, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2815 FRAME_PTR f, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2816 widget_value *val, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2817 GCallback select_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2818 GCallback deactivate_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2819 GCallback highlight_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2820 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data) |
49323 | 2821 { |
2822 GtkWidget *newsub = submenu; | |
2823 GList *list = 0; | |
2824 GList *iter; | |
2825 widget_value *cur; | |
2826 int has_tearoff_p = 0; | |
2827 GList *first_radio = 0; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2828 |
49323 | 2829 if (submenu) |
2830 list = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (submenu)); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2831 |
49323 | 2832 for (cur = val, iter = list; |
2833 cur && iter; | |
2834 iter = g_list_next (iter), cur = cur->next) | |
2835 { | |
2836 GtkWidget *w = GTK_WIDGET (iter->data); | |
2837 | |
2838 /* Skip tearoff items, they have no counterpart in val. */ | |
2839 if (GTK_IS_TEAROFF_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2840 { | |
2841 has_tearoff_p = 1; | |
2842 iter = g_list_next (iter); | |
2843 if (iter) w = GTK_WIDGET (iter->data); | |
2844 else break; | |
2845 } | |
2846 | |
2847 /* Remember first radio button in a group. If we get a mismatch in | |
2848 a radio group we must rebuild the whole group so that the connections | |
2849 in GTK becomes correct. */ | |
2850 if (cur->button_type == BUTTON_TYPE_RADIO && ! first_radio) | |
2851 first_radio = iter; | |
2852 else if (cur->button_type != BUTTON_TYPE_RADIO | |
2853 && ! GTK_IS_RADIO_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2854 first_radio = 0; | |
2855 | |
2856 if (GTK_IS_SEPARATOR_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2857 { | |
111991
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
2858 if (! menu_separator_name_p (cur->name)) |
49323 | 2859 break; |
2860 } | |
2861 else if (GTK_IS_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2862 { | |
2863 if (cur->button_type != BUTTON_TYPE_TOGGLE) | |
2864 break; | |
2865 xg_update_toggle_item (cur, w); | |
2866 xg_update_menu_item (cur, w, select_cb, highlight_cb, cl_data); | |
2867 } | |
2868 else if (GTK_IS_RADIO_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2869 { | |
2870 if (cur->button_type != BUTTON_TYPE_RADIO) | |
2871 break; | |
2872 xg_update_radio_item (cur, w); | |
2873 xg_update_menu_item (cur, w, select_cb, highlight_cb, cl_data); | |
2874 } | |
2875 else if (GTK_IS_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2876 { | |
2877 GtkMenuItem *witem = GTK_MENU_ITEM (w); | |
2878 GtkWidget *sub; | |
2879 | |
2880 if (cur->button_type != BUTTON_TYPE_NONE || | |
111991
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
2881 menu_separator_name_p (cur->name)) |
49323 | 2882 break; |
2883 | |
2884 xg_update_menu_item (cur, w, select_cb, highlight_cb, cl_data); | |
2885 | |
2886 sub = gtk_menu_item_get_submenu (witem); | |
2887 if (sub && ! cur->contents) | |
2888 { | |
2889 /* Not a submenu anymore. */ | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2890 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (sub)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2891 remove_submenu (witem); |
49323 | 2892 gtk_widget_destroy (sub); |
2893 } | |
2894 else if (cur->contents) | |
2895 { | |
2896 GtkWidget *nsub; | |
2897 | |
2898 nsub = xg_update_submenu (sub, f, cur->contents, | |
2899 select_cb, deactivate_cb, | |
2900 highlight_cb, cl_data); | |
2901 | |
2902 /* If this item just became a submenu, we must set it. */ | |
2903 if (nsub != sub) | |
2904 gtk_menu_item_set_submenu (witem, nsub); | |
2905 } | |
2906 } | |
2907 else | |
2908 { | |
2909 /* Structural difference. Remove everything from here and down | |
2910 in SUBMENU. */ | |
2911 break; | |
2912 } | |
2913 } | |
2914 | |
2915 /* Remove widgets from first structual change. */ | |
2916 if (iter) | |
2917 { | |
2918 /* If we are adding new menu items below, we must remove from | |
2919 first radio button so that radio groups become correct. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2920 if (cur && first_radio) xg_destroy_widgets (first_radio); |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2921 else xg_destroy_widgets (iter); |
49323 | 2922 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2923 |
49323 | 2924 if (cur) |
2925 { | |
2926 /* More items added. Create them. */ | |
2927 newsub = create_menus (cur, | |
2928 f, | |
2929 select_cb, | |
2930 deactivate_cb, | |
2931 highlight_cb, | |
2932 0, | |
2933 0, | |
2934 ! has_tearoff_p, | |
2935 submenu, | |
2936 cl_data, | |
2937 0); | |
2938 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2939 |
49572 | 2940 if (list) g_list_free (list); |
2941 | |
49323 | 2942 return newsub; |
2943 } | |
2944 | |
2945 /* Update the MENUBAR. | |
2946 F is the frame the menu bar belongs to. | |
2947 VAL describes the contents of the menu bar. | |
2948 If DEEP_P is non-zero, rebuild all but the top level menu names in | |
2949 the MENUBAR. If DEEP_P is zero, just rebuild the names in the menubar. | |
2950 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2951 DEACTIVATE_CB is the callback to use when a sub menu is not shown anymore. | |
2952 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2953 |
49323 | 2954 void |
109364
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
2955 xg_modify_menubar_widgets (GtkWidget *menubar, FRAME_PTR f, widget_value *val, |
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
2956 int deep_p, |
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
2957 GCallback select_cb, GCallback deactivate_cb, |
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
2958 GCallback highlight_cb) |
49323 | 2959 { |
2960 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data; | |
2961 GList *list = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar)); | |
2962 | |
2963 if (! list) return; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2964 |
49323 | 2965 cl_data = (xg_menu_cb_data*) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (menubar), |
2966 XG_FRAME_DATA); | |
2967 | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2968 xg_update_menubar (menubar, f, &list, list, 0, val->contents, |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
2969 select_cb, deactivate_cb, highlight_cb, cl_data); |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2970 |
64783
0975467abc17
* gtkutil.c (xg_modify_menubar_widgets): Remove semicolon that
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
2971 if (deep_p) |
49323 | 2972 { |
2973 widget_value *cur; | |
2974 | |
2975 /* Update all sub menus. | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2976 We must keep the submenus (GTK menu item widgets) since the |
49323 | 2977 X Window in the XEvent that activates the menu are those widgets. */ |
2978 | |
2979 /* Update cl_data, menu_item things in F may have changed. */ | |
2980 update_cl_data (cl_data, f, highlight_cb); | |
2981 | |
2982 for (cur = val->contents; cur; cur = cur->next) | |
2983 { | |
49572 | 2984 GList *iter; |
49323 | 2985 GtkWidget *sub = 0; |
2986 GtkWidget *newsub; | |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2987 GtkMenuItem *witem = 0; |
49323 | 2988 |
2989 /* Find sub menu that corresponds to val and update it. */ | |
2990 for (iter = list ; iter; iter = g_list_next (iter)) | |
2991 { | |
2992 witem = GTK_MENU_ITEM (iter->data); | |
2993 if (xg_item_label_same_p (witem, cur->name)) | |
2994 { | |
2995 sub = gtk_menu_item_get_submenu (witem); | |
2996 break; | |
2997 } | |
2998 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2999 |
49323 | 3000 newsub = xg_update_submenu (sub, |
3001 f, | |
3002 cur->contents, | |
3003 select_cb, | |
3004 deactivate_cb, | |
3005 highlight_cb, | |
3006 cl_data); | |
3007 /* sub may still be NULL. If we just updated non deep and added | |
3008 a new menu bar item, it has no sub menu yet. So we set the | |
3009 newly created sub menu under witem. */ | |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3010 if (newsub != sub && witem != 0) |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3011 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3012 xg_set_screen (newsub, f); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3013 gtk_menu_item_set_submenu (witem, newsub); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3014 } |
49323 | 3015 } |
3016 } | |
3017 | |
49572 | 3018 g_list_free (list); |
49323 | 3019 gtk_widget_show_all (menubar); |
3020 } | |
3021 | |
111746 | 3022 /* Callback called when the menu bar W is mapped. |
3023 Used to find the height of the menu bar if we didn't get it | |
3024 after showing the widget. */ | |
3025 | |
3026 static void | |
3027 menubar_map_cb (GtkWidget *w, gpointer user_data) | |
3028 { | |
3029 GtkRequisition req; | |
3030 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) user_data; | |
3031 gtk_widget_size_request (w, &req); | |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3032 if (FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) != req.height) |
111746 | 3033 { |
3034 FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; | |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3035 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
111746 | 3036 } |
3037 } | |
3038 | |
49323 | 3039 /* Recompute all the widgets of frame F, when the menu bar has been |
3040 changed. Value is non-zero if widgets were updated. */ | |
3041 | |
3042 int | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3043 xg_update_frame_menubar (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 3044 { |
3045 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; | |
3046 GtkRequisition req; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3047 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3048 if (!x->menubar_widget || gtk_widget_get_mapped (x->menubar_widget)) |
49323 | 3049 return 0; |
3050 | |
106012
fae53e3bfda0
gtkutil.c (xg_update_frame_menubar): Do nothing if menubar already has a parent.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105959
diff
changeset
|
3051 if (x->menubar_widget && gtk_widget_get_parent (x->menubar_widget)) |
fae53e3bfda0
gtkutil.c (xg_update_frame_menubar): Do nothing if menubar already has a parent.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105959
diff
changeset
|
3052 return 0; /* Already done this, happens for frames created invisible. */ |
fae53e3bfda0
gtkutil.c (xg_update_frame_menubar): Do nothing if menubar already has a parent.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105959
diff
changeset
|
3053 |
49323 | 3054 BLOCK_INPUT; |
3055 | |
3056 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (x->vbox_widget), x->menubar_widget, | |
3057 FALSE, FALSE, 0); | |
3058 gtk_box_reorder_child (GTK_BOX (x->vbox_widget), x->menubar_widget, 0); | |
3059 | |
111746 | 3060 g_signal_connect (x->menubar_widget, "map", G_CALLBACK (menubar_map_cb), f); |
49323 | 3061 gtk_widget_show_all (x->menubar_widget); |
3062 gtk_widget_size_request (x->menubar_widget, &req); | |
111779 | 3063 |
111746 | 3064 /* If menu bar doesn't know its height yet, cheat a little so the frame |
3065 doesn't jump so much when resized later in menubar_map_cb. */ | |
3066 if (req.height == 0) | |
3067 req.height = 23; | |
3068 | |
3069 if (FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) != req.height) | |
3070 { | |
3071 FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; | |
111779 | 3072 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
111746 | 3073 } |
49323 | 3074 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
50106
5675d6a0080c
(xg_update_frame_menubar): Add missing return value.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
50099
diff
changeset
|
3075 |
5675d6a0080c
(xg_update_frame_menubar): Add missing return value.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
50099
diff
changeset
|
3076 return 1; |
49323 | 3077 } |
3078 | |
3079 /* Get rid of the menu bar of frame F, and free its storage. | |
3080 This is used when deleting a frame, and when turning off the menu bar. */ | |
3081 | |
3082 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3083 free_frame_menubar (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 3084 { |
3085 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; | |
3086 | |
3087 if (x->menubar_widget) | |
3088 { | |
3089 BLOCK_INPUT; | |
3090 | |
3091 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (x->vbox_widget), x->menubar_widget); | |
3092 /* The menubar and its children shall be deleted when removed from | |
3093 the container. */ | |
3094 x->menubar_widget = 0; | |
3095 FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) = 0; | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3096 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
49323 | 3097 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
3098 } | |
3099 } | |
3100 | |
109327
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3101 int |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3102 xg_event_is_for_menubar (FRAME_PTR f, XEvent *event) |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3103 { |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3104 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
109332
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3105 GList *iter; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3106 GdkRectangle rec; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3107 GList *list; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3108 GdkDisplay *gdpy; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3109 GdkWindow *gw; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3110 GdkEvent gevent; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3111 GtkWidget *gwdesc; |
109327
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3112 |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3113 if (! x->menubar_widget) return 0; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3114 |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3115 if (! (event->xbutton.x >= 0 |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3116 && event->xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3117 && event->xbutton.y >= 0 |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3118 && event->xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3119 && event->xbutton.same_screen)) |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3120 return 0; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3121 |
109332
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3122 gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)); |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3123 gw = gdk_xid_table_lookup_for_display (gdpy, event->xbutton.window); |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3124 if (! gw) return 0; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3125 gevent.any.window = gw; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3126 gwdesc = gtk_get_event_widget (&gevent); |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3127 if (! gwdesc) return 0; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3128 if (! GTK_IS_MENU_BAR (gwdesc) |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3129 && ! GTK_IS_MENU_ITEM (gwdesc) |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3130 && ! gtk_widget_is_ancestor (x->menubar_widget, gwdesc)) |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3131 return 0; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3132 |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3133 list = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (x->menubar_widget)); |
109327
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3134 if (! list) return 0; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3135 rec.x = event->xbutton.x; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3136 rec.y = event->xbutton.y; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3137 rec.width = 1; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3138 rec.height = 1; |
109332
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3139 |
109327
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3140 for (iter = list ; iter; iter = g_list_next (iter)) |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3141 { |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3142 GtkWidget *w = GTK_WIDGET (iter->data); |
109454
514fed5c0ded
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_resized): GTK_IS_MAPPED => gtk_widget_get_mapped, for Gtk 3.0
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109452
diff
changeset
|
3143 if (gtk_widget_get_mapped (w) && gtk_widget_intersect (w, &rec, NULL)) |
109327
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3144 break; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3145 } |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3146 g_list_free (list); |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3147 return iter == 0 ? 0 : 1; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3148 } |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3149 |
49323 | 3150 |
3151 | |
3152 /*********************************************************************** | |
3153 Scroll bar functions | |
3154 ***********************************************************************/ | |
3155 | |
3156 | |
3157 /* Setting scroll bar values invokes the callback. Use this variable | |
3158 to indicate that callback should do nothing. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3159 |
49323 | 3160 int xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar; |
3161 | |
86161
3408ab8b4152
* xterm.h (struct scroll_bar): Only use Lisp_Object for lisp data.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85938
diff
changeset
|
3162 /* Xlib's `Window' fits in 32 bits. But we want to store pointers, and they |
3408ab8b4152
* xterm.h (struct scroll_bar): Only use Lisp_Object for lisp data.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85938
diff
changeset
|
3163 may be larger than 32 bits. Keep a mapping from integer index to widget |
3408ab8b4152
* xterm.h (struct scroll_bar): Only use Lisp_Object for lisp data.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85938
diff
changeset
|
3164 pointers to get around the 32 bit limitation. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3165 |
49323 | 3166 static struct |
3167 { | |
3168 GtkWidget **widgets; | |
3169 int max_size; | |
3170 int used; | |
49419
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
3171 } id_to_widget; |
49323 | 3172 |
3173 /* Grow this much every time we need to allocate more */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3174 |
49323 | 3175 #define ID_TO_WIDGET_INCR 32 |
3176 | |
3177 /* Store the widget pointer W in id_to_widget and return the integer index. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3178 |
49323 | 3179 static int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3180 xg_store_widget_in_map (GtkWidget *w) |
49323 | 3181 { |
3182 int i; | |
3183 | |
3184 if (id_to_widget.max_size == id_to_widget.used) | |
3185 { | |
3186 int new_size = id_to_widget.max_size + ID_TO_WIDGET_INCR; | |
3187 | |
3188 id_to_widget.widgets = xrealloc (id_to_widget.widgets, | |
3189 sizeof (GtkWidget *)*new_size); | |
3190 | |
3191 for (i = id_to_widget.max_size; i < new_size; ++i) | |
3192 id_to_widget.widgets[i] = 0; | |
3193 id_to_widget.max_size = new_size; | |
3194 } | |
3195 | |
3196 /* Just loop over the array and find a free place. After all, | |
3197 how many scroll bars are we creating? Should be a small number. | |
3198 The check above guarantees we will find a free place. */ | |
3199 for (i = 0; i < id_to_widget.max_size; ++i) | |
3200 { | |
3201 if (! id_to_widget.widgets[i]) | |
3202 { | |
3203 id_to_widget.widgets[i] = w; | |
3204 ++id_to_widget.used; | |
3205 | |
3206 return i; | |
3207 } | |
3208 } | |
3209 | |
3210 /* Should never end up here */ | |
3211 abort (); | |
3212 } | |
3213 | |
3214 /* Remove pointer at IDX from id_to_widget. | |
3215 Called when scroll bar is destroyed. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3216 |
49323 | 3217 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3218 xg_remove_widget_from_map (int idx) |
49323 | 3219 { |
3220 if (idx < id_to_widget.max_size && id_to_widget.widgets[idx] != 0) | |
3221 { | |
3222 id_to_widget.widgets[idx] = 0; | |
3223 --id_to_widget.used; | |
3224 } | |
3225 } | |
3226 | |
3227 /* Get the widget pointer at IDX from id_to_widget. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3228 |
49323 | 3229 static GtkWidget * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3230 xg_get_widget_from_map (int idx) |
49323 | 3231 { |
3232 if (idx < id_to_widget.max_size && id_to_widget.widgets[idx] != 0) | |
3233 return id_to_widget.widgets[idx]; | |
3234 | |
3235 return 0; | |
3236 } | |
3237 | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3238 /* Return the scrollbar id for X Window WID on display DPY. |
50063 | 3239 Return -1 if WID not in id_to_widget. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3240 |
50063 | 3241 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3242 xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (Display *dpy, Window wid) |
50063 | 3243 { |
3244 int idx; | |
3245 GtkWidget *w; | |
3246 | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3247 w = xg_win_to_widget (dpy, wid); |
50063 | 3248 |
3249 if (w) | |
3250 { | |
3251 for (idx = 0; idx < id_to_widget.max_size; ++idx) | |
3252 if (id_to_widget.widgets[idx] == w) | |
3253 return idx; | |
3254 } | |
3255 | |
3256 return -1; | |
3257 } | |
3258 | |
49323 | 3259 /* Callback invoked when scroll bar WIDGET is destroyed. |
3260 DATA is the index into id_to_widget for WIDGET. | |
50129
d0142038feaa
Reduce flicker in GTK scrollbars.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50112
diff
changeset
|
3261 We free pointer to last scroll bar values here and remove the index. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3262 |
49323 | 3263 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3264 xg_gtk_scroll_destroy (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer data) |
49323 | 3265 { |
59411
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3266 int id = (int) (EMACS_INT) data; /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
49323 | 3267 xg_remove_widget_from_map (id); |
3268 } | |
3269 | |
3270 /* Create a scroll bar widget for frame F. Store the scroll bar | |
3271 in BAR. | |
3272 SCROLL_CALLBACK is the callback to invoke when the value of the | |
3273 bar changes. | |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3274 END_CALLBACK is the callback to invoke when scrolling ends. |
49323 | 3275 SCROLL_BAR_NAME is the name we use for the scroll bar. Can be used |
3276 to set resources for the widget. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3277 |
49323 | 3278 void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3279 xg_create_scroll_bar (FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3280 struct scroll_bar *bar, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3281 GCallback scroll_callback, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3282 GCallback end_callback, |
109717
8949aad5e992
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109668
diff
changeset
|
3283 const char *scroll_bar_name) |
49323 | 3284 { |
3285 GtkWidget *wscroll; | |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3286 GtkWidget *webox; |
49323 | 3287 GtkObject *vadj; |
3288 int scroll_id; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3289 |
49323 | 3290 /* Page, step increment values are not so important here, they |
3291 will be corrected in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb. */ | |
3292 vadj = gtk_adjustment_new (XG_SB_MIN, XG_SB_MIN, XG_SB_MAX, | |
3293 0.1, 0.1, 0.1); | |
3294 | |
3295 wscroll = gtk_vscrollbar_new (GTK_ADJUSTMENT (vadj)); | |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3296 webox = gtk_event_box_new (); |
49323 | 3297 gtk_widget_set_name (wscroll, scroll_bar_name); |
3298 gtk_range_set_update_policy (GTK_RANGE (wscroll), GTK_UPDATE_CONTINUOUS); | |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3299 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wscroll), XG_FRAME_DATA, (gpointer)f); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3300 |
49323 | 3301 scroll_id = xg_store_widget_in_map (wscroll); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3302 |
59411
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3303 /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
49323 | 3304 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wscroll), |
3305 "destroy", | |
3306 G_CALLBACK (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy), | |
59411
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3307 (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) scroll_id); |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3308 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wscroll), |
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3309 "change-value", |
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3310 scroll_callback, |
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3311 (gpointer) bar); |
106549
3acd32c3e0ac
gtkutil.c: Scroll bar thumb not updated properly (bug #5177).
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106512
diff
changeset
|
3312 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wscroll), |
3acd32c3e0ac
gtkutil.c: Scroll bar thumb not updated properly (bug #5177).
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106512
diff
changeset
|
3313 "button-release-event", |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3314 end_callback, |
106549
3acd32c3e0ac
gtkutil.c: Scroll bar thumb not updated properly (bug #5177).
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106512
diff
changeset
|
3315 (gpointer) bar); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3316 |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3317 /* The scroll bar widget does not draw on a window of its own. Instead |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3318 it draws on the parent window, in this case the edit widget. So |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3319 whenever the edit widget is cleared, the scroll bar needs to redraw |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3320 also, which causes flicker. Put an event box between the edit widget |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3321 and the scroll bar, so the scroll bar instead draws itself on the |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3322 event box window. */ |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3323 gtk_fixed_put (GTK_FIXED (f->output_data.x->edit_widget), webox, -1, -1); |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3324 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (webox), wscroll); |
60185
391f44959566
(xg_create_frame_widgets): UNBLOCK_INPUT on error.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59913
diff
changeset
|
3325 |
49323 | 3326 |
3327 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. */ | |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3328 xg_set_cursor (webox, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->xg_cursor); |
49323 | 3329 |
86161
3408ab8b4152
* xterm.h (struct scroll_bar): Only use Lisp_Object for lisp data.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85938
diff
changeset
|
3330 bar->x_window = scroll_id; |
49323 | 3331 } |
3332 | |
3333 /* Remove the scroll bar represented by SCROLLBAR_ID from the frame F. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3334 |
49323 | 3335 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3336 xg_remove_scroll_bar (FRAME_PTR f, int scrollbar_id) |
49323 | 3337 { |
3338 GtkWidget *w = xg_get_widget_from_map (scrollbar_id); | |
3339 if (w) | |
3340 { | |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3341 GtkWidget *wparent = gtk_widget_get_parent (w); |
49323 | 3342 gtk_widget_destroy (w); |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3343 gtk_widget_destroy (wparent); |
49323 | 3344 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
3345 } | |
3346 } | |
3347 | |
3348 /* Update the position of the vertical scroll bar represented by SCROLLBAR_ID | |
3349 in frame F. | |
3350 TOP/LEFT are the new pixel positions where the bar shall appear. | |
3351 WIDTH, HEIGHT is the size in pixels the bar shall have. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3352 |
49323 | 3353 void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3354 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3355 int scrollbar_id, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3356 int top, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3357 int left, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3358 int width, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3359 int height) |
49323 | 3360 { |
49572 | 3361 |
3362 GtkWidget *wscroll = xg_get_widget_from_map (scrollbar_id); | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3363 |
49572 | 3364 if (wscroll) |
3365 { | |
50177
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3366 GtkWidget *wfixed = f->output_data.x->edit_widget; |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3367 GtkWidget *wparent = gtk_widget_get_parent (wscroll); |
109040
98796fa1a7f8
src/gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Avoid C99 mid-block variable declaration.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
109037
diff
changeset
|
3368 gint msl; |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3369 |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3370 /* Clear out old position. */ |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3371 int oldx = -1, oldy = -1, oldw, oldh; |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3372 if (gtk_widget_get_parent (wparent) == wfixed) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3373 { |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3374 gtk_container_child_get (GTK_CONTAINER (wfixed), wparent, |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3375 "x", &oldx, "y", &oldy, NULL); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3376 gtk_widget_get_size_request (wscroll, &oldw, &oldh); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3377 } |
55342
44d086f5e08a
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call XClearWindow to clear
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
53275
diff
changeset
|
3378 |
44d086f5e08a
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call XClearWindow to clear
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
53275
diff
changeset
|
3379 /* Move and resize to new values. */ |
60553
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3380 gtk_fixed_move (GTK_FIXED (wfixed), wparent, left, top); |
109037
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3381 gtk_widget_style_get (wscroll, "min-slider-length", &msl, NULL); |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3382 if (msl > height) |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3383 { |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3384 /* No room. Hide scroll bar as some themes output a warning if |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3385 the height is less than the min size. */ |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3386 gtk_widget_hide (wparent); |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3387 gtk_widget_hide (wscroll); |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3388 } |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3389 else |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3390 { |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3391 gtk_widget_show_all (wparent); |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3392 gtk_widget_set_size_request (wscroll, width, height); |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3393 } |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3394 gtk_widget_queue_draw (wfixed); |
60553
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3395 gdk_window_process_all_updates (); |
109037
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3396 if (oldx != -1 && oldw > 0 && oldh > 0) |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3397 { |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3398 /* Clear under old scroll bar position. This must be done after |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3399 the gtk_widget_queue_draw and gdk_window_process_all_updates |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3400 above. */ |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3401 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3402 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3403 oldx, oldy, oldw, oldh, 0); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3404 } |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3405 |
60553
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3406 /* GTK does not redraw until the main loop is entered again, but |
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3407 if there are no X events pending we will not enter it. So we sync |
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3408 here to get some events. */ |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3409 |
60553
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3410 x_sync (f); |
49572 | 3411 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
3412 cancel_mouse_face (f); | |
3413 } | |
49323 | 3414 } |
3415 | |
3416 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently | |
3417 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3418 |
49323 | 3419 void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3420 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3421 int portion, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3422 int position, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3423 int whole) |
49323 | 3424 { |
86161
3408ab8b4152
* xterm.h (struct scroll_bar): Only use Lisp_Object for lisp data.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85938
diff
changeset
|
3425 GtkWidget *wscroll = xg_get_widget_from_map (bar->x_window); |
49323 | 3426 |
3427 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window))); | |
3428 | |
50177
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3429 if (wscroll && NILP (bar->dragging)) |
49323 | 3430 { |
3431 GtkAdjustment *adj; | |
3432 gdouble shown; | |
3433 gdouble top; | |
3434 int size, value; | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3435 int new_step; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3436 int changed = 0; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3437 |
49323 | 3438 adj = gtk_range_get_adjustment (GTK_RANGE (wscroll)); |
3439 | |
50177
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3440 /* We do the same as for MOTIF in xterm.c, assume 30 chars per line |
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3441 rather than the real portion value. This makes the thumb less likely |
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3442 to resize and that looks better. */ |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
3443 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30; |
50177
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3444 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole. |
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3445 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */ |
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3446 whole += portion; |
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3447 |
49323 | 3448 if (whole <= 0) |
3449 top = 0, shown = 1; | |
3450 else | |
3451 { | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3452 top = (gdouble) position / whole; |
49323 | 3453 shown = (gdouble) portion / whole; |
3454 } | |
3455 | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3456 size = shown * XG_SB_RANGE; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3457 size = min (size, XG_SB_RANGE); |
49323 | 3458 size = max (size, 1); |
3459 | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3460 value = top * XG_SB_RANGE; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3461 value = min (value, XG_SB_MAX - size); |
49323 | 3462 value = max (value, XG_SB_MIN); |
3463 | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3464 /* Assume all lines are of equal size. */ |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
3465 new_step = size / max (1, FRAME_LINES (f)); |
50178
61194aef8668
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb): Check if new values
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50177
diff
changeset
|
3466 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3467 if ((int) gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj) != size |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3468 || (int) gtk_adjustment_get_step_increment (adj) != new_step) |
50178
61194aef8668
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb): Check if new values
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50177
diff
changeset
|
3469 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3470 gtk_adjustment_set_page_size (adj, size); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3471 gtk_adjustment_set_step_increment (adj, new_step); |
50178
61194aef8668
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb): Check if new values
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50177
diff
changeset
|
3472 /* Assume a page increment is about 95% of the page size */ |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3473 gtk_adjustment_set_page_increment (adj,(int) (0.95*size)); |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3474 changed = 1; |
50178
61194aef8668
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb): Check if new values
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50177
diff
changeset
|
3475 } |
61194aef8668
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb): Check if new values
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50177
diff
changeset
|
3476 |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3477 if (changed || (int) gtk_range_get_value (GTK_RANGE (wscroll)) != value) |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3478 { |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3479 BLOCK_INPUT; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3480 |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3481 /* gtk_range_set_value invokes the callback. Set |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3482 ignore_gtk_scrollbar to make the callback do nothing */ |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3483 xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar = 1; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3484 |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3485 if ((int) gtk_range_get_value (GTK_RANGE (wscroll)) != value) |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3486 gtk_range_set_value (GTK_RANGE (wscroll), (gdouble)value); |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3487 else if (changed) |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3488 gtk_adjustment_changed (adj); |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3489 |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3490 xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar = 0; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3491 |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3492 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3493 } |
49323 | 3494 } |
3495 } | |
3496 | |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3497 /* Return non-zero if EVENT is for a scroll bar in frame F. |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3498 When the same X window is used for several Gtk+ widgets, we cannot |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3499 say for sure based on the X window alone if an event is for the |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3500 frame. This function does additional checks. |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3501 |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3502 Return non-zero if the event is for a scroll bar, zero otherwise. */ |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3503 |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3504 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3505 xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (FRAME_PTR f, XEvent *event) |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3506 { |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3507 int retval = 0; |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3508 |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3509 if (f && event->type == ButtonPress && event->xbutton.button < 4) |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3510 { |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3511 /* Check if press occurred outside the edit widget. */ |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3512 GdkDisplay *gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)); |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3513 retval = gdk_display_get_window_at_pointer (gdpy, NULL, NULL) |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3514 != gtk_widget_get_window (f->output_data.x->edit_widget); |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3515 } |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3516 else if (f |
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3517 && ((event->type == ButtonRelease && event->xbutton.button < 4) |
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3518 || event->type == MotionNotify)) |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3519 { |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3520 /* If we are releasing or moving the scroll bar, it has the grab. */ |
107997
d94009e7a0cc
gtkutils.c (xg_event_is_for_scrollbar): Check if grabbed widget is a scrollbar.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107891
diff
changeset
|
3521 GtkWidget *w = gtk_grab_get_current (); |
d94009e7a0cc
gtkutils.c (xg_event_is_for_scrollbar): Check if grabbed widget is a scrollbar.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107891
diff
changeset
|
3522 retval = w != 0 && GTK_IS_SCROLLBAR (w); |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3523 } |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3524 |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3525 return retval; |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3526 } |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3527 |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3528 |
49323 | 3529 |
3530 /*********************************************************************** | |
3531 Tool bar functions | |
3532 ***********************************************************************/ | |
3533 /* The key for the data we put in the GtkImage widgets. The data is | |
3534 the image used by Emacs. We use this to see if we need to update | |
3535 the GtkImage with a new image. */ | |
3536 #define XG_TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DATA "emacs-tool-bar-image" | |
3537 | |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3538 /* The key for storing the latest modifiers so the activate callback can |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3539 get them. */ |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3540 #define XG_TOOL_BAR_LAST_MODIFIER "emacs-tool-bar-modifier" |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3541 |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3542 /* The key for storing the button widget in its proxy menu item. */ |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3543 #define XG_TOOL_BAR_PROXY_BUTTON "emacs-tool-bar-proxy-button" |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3544 |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3545 /* The key for the data we put in the GtkImage widgets. The data is |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3546 the stock name used by Emacs. We use this to see if we need to update |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3547 the GtkImage with a new image. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3548 #define XG_TOOL_BAR_STOCK_NAME "emacs-tool-bar-stock-name" |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3549 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3550 /* As above, but this is used for named theme widgets, as opposed to |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3551 stock items. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3552 #define XG_TOOL_BAR_ICON_NAME "emacs-tool-bar-icon-name" |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3553 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3554 /* Callback function invoked when a tool bar item is pressed. |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3555 W is the button widget in the tool bar that got pressed, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3556 CLIENT_DATA is an integer that is the index of the button in the |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3557 tool bar. 0 is the first button. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3558 |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3559 static gboolean |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3560 xg_tool_bar_button_cb (GtkWidget *widget, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3561 GdkEventButton *event, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3562 gpointer user_data) |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3563 { |
73389
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
3564 /* Casts to avoid warnings when gpointer is 64 bits and int is 32 bits */ |
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
3565 gpointer ptr = (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) event->state; |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3566 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_TOOL_BAR_LAST_MODIFIER, ptr); |
68922 | 3567 return FALSE; |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3568 } |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3569 |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3570 |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3571 /* Callback function invoked when a tool bar item is pressed. |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3572 W is the button widget in the tool bar that got pressed, |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3573 CLIENT_DATA is an integer that is the index of the button in the |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3574 tool bar. 0 is the first button. */ |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3575 |
49323 | 3576 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3577 xg_tool_bar_callback (GtkWidget *w, gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 3578 { |
59411
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3579 /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3580 int idx = (int) (EMACS_INT) client_data; |
73389
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
3581 int mod = (int) (EMACS_INT) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), |
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
3582 XG_TOOL_BAR_LAST_MODIFIER); |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3583 |
49323 | 3584 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), XG_FRAME_DATA); |
3585 Lisp_Object key, frame; | |
3586 struct input_event event; | |
51569
e7bd8581e306
(xg_tool_bar_callback): Don't pass uninitialized
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
51432
diff
changeset
|
3587 EVENT_INIT (event); |
49323 | 3588 |
3589 if (! f || ! f->n_tool_bar_items || NILP (f->tool_bar_items)) | |
3590 return; | |
3591 | |
3592 idx *= TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3593 |
49323 | 3594 key = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_KEY); |
3595 XSETFRAME (frame, f); | |
78538
2fcf45c12927
(update_frame_tool_bar): Use -1 as index
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78260
diff
changeset
|
3596 |
2fcf45c12927
(update_frame_tool_bar): Use -1 as index
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78260
diff
changeset
|
3597 /* We generate two events here. The first one is to set the prefix |
2fcf45c12927
(update_frame_tool_bar): Use -1 as index
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78260
diff
changeset
|
3598 to `(tool_bar)', see keyboard.c. */ |
49323 | 3599 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT; |
3600 event.frame_or_window = frame; | |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3601 event.arg = frame; |
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3602 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event); |
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3603 |
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3604 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT; |
49323 | 3605 event.frame_or_window = frame; |
3606 event.arg = key; | |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3607 /* Convert between the modifier bits GDK uses and the modifier bits |
102549
f737bc68655e
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_callback): Set focus back to the frame
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102358
diff
changeset
|
3608 Emacs uses. This assumes GDK and X masks are the same, which they are when |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3609 this is written. */ |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3610 event.modifiers = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), mod); |
49323 | 3611 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3612 |
102549
f737bc68655e
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_callback): Set focus back to the frame
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102358
diff
changeset
|
3613 /* Return focus to the frame after we have clicked on a detached |
f737bc68655e
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_callback): Set focus back to the frame
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102358
diff
changeset
|
3614 tool bar button. */ |
f737bc68655e
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_callback): Set focus back to the frame
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102358
diff
changeset
|
3615 Fx_focus_frame (frame); |
49323 | 3616 } |
3617 | |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3618 /* Callback function invoked when a tool bar item is pressed in a detached |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3619 tool bar or the overflow drop down menu. |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3620 We just call xg_tool_bar_callback. |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3621 W is the menu item widget that got pressed, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3622 CLIENT_DATA is an integer that is the index of the button in the |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3623 tool bar. 0 is the first button. */ |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3624 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3625 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3626 xg_tool_bar_proxy_callback (GtkWidget *w, gpointer client_data) |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3627 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3628 GtkWidget *wbutton = GTK_WIDGET (g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3629 XG_TOOL_BAR_PROXY_BUTTON)); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3630 xg_tool_bar_callback (wbutton, client_data); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3631 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3632 |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3633 |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3634 static gboolean |
109100
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109067
diff
changeset
|
3635 xg_tool_bar_help_callback (GtkWidget *w, |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109067
diff
changeset
|
3636 GdkEventCrossing *event, |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109067
diff
changeset
|
3637 gpointer client_data); |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3638 |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3639 /* This callback is called when a help is to be shown for an item in |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3640 the detached tool bar when the detached tool bar it is not expanded. */ |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3641 |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3642 static gboolean |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3643 xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback (GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3644 GdkEventCrossing *event, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3645 gpointer client_data) |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3646 { |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3647 GtkWidget *wbutton = GTK_WIDGET (g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3648 XG_TOOL_BAR_PROXY_BUTTON)); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3649 |
106512
471e6932ea09
(xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): Fix missing return.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
106186
diff
changeset
|
3650 return xg_tool_bar_help_callback (wbutton, event, client_data); |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3651 } |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3652 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3653 static GtkWidget * |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3654 xg_get_tool_bar_widgets (GtkWidget *vb, GtkWidget **wimage) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3655 { |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3656 GList *clist = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (vb)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3657 GtkWidget *c1 = (GtkWidget *) clist->data; |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
3658 GtkWidget *c2 = clist->next ? (GtkWidget *) clist->next->data : NULL; |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
3659 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3660 *wimage = GTK_IS_IMAGE (c1) ? c1 : c2; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3661 g_list_free (clist); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3662 return GTK_IS_LABEL (c1) ? c1 : c2; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3663 } |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3664 |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3665 |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3666 /* This callback is called when a tool item should create a proxy item, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3667 such as for the overflow menu. Also called when the tool bar is detached. |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3668 If we don't create a proxy menu item, the detached tool bar will be |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3669 blank. */ |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3670 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3671 static gboolean |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3672 xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy (GtkToolItem *toolitem, gpointer user_data) |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3673 { |
111991
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
3674 GtkButton *wbutton = GTK_BUTTON (XG_BIN_CHILD (XG_BIN_CHILD (toolitem))); |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
3675 GtkWidget *vb = XG_BIN_CHILD (wbutton); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3676 GtkWidget *c1; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3677 GtkLabel *wlbl = GTK_LABEL (xg_get_tool_bar_widgets (vb, &c1)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3678 GtkImage *wimage = GTK_IMAGE (c1); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3679 GtkWidget *wmenuitem = gtk_image_menu_item_new_with_label |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3680 (gtk_label_get_text (wlbl)); |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3681 GtkWidget *wmenuimage; |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3682 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3683 |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3684 if (gtk_button_get_use_stock (wbutton)) |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3685 wmenuimage = gtk_image_new_from_stock (gtk_button_get_label (wbutton), |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3686 GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3687 else |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3688 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3689 GtkSettings *settings = gtk_widget_get_settings (GTK_WIDGET (wbutton)); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3690 GtkImageType store_type = gtk_image_get_storage_type (wimage); |
85938
d7e05ac913d8
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
84621
diff
changeset
|
3691 |
110521
1cdff3b101d6
Make sure detached tool bar menu isn't blank.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109332
diff
changeset
|
3692 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (settings), "gtk-menu-images", TRUE, NULL); |
1cdff3b101d6
Make sure detached tool bar menu isn't blank.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109332
diff
changeset
|
3693 |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3694 if (store_type == GTK_IMAGE_STOCK) |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3695 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3696 gchar *stock_id; |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3697 gtk_image_get_stock (wimage, &stock_id, NULL); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3698 wmenuimage = gtk_image_new_from_stock (stock_id, GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3699 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3700 else if (store_type == GTK_IMAGE_ICON_SET) |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3701 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3702 GtkIconSet *icon_set; |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3703 gtk_image_get_icon_set (wimage, &icon_set, NULL); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3704 wmenuimage = gtk_image_new_from_icon_set (icon_set, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3705 GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3706 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3707 else if (store_type == GTK_IMAGE_PIXBUF) |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3708 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3709 gint width, height; |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3710 |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3711 if (settings && |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3712 gtk_icon_size_lookup_for_settings (settings, GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3713 &width, &height)) |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3714 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3715 GdkPixbuf *src_pixbuf, *dest_pixbuf; |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3716 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3717 src_pixbuf = gtk_image_get_pixbuf (wimage); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3718 dest_pixbuf = gdk_pixbuf_scale_simple (src_pixbuf, width, height, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3719 GDK_INTERP_BILINEAR); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3720 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3721 wmenuimage = gtk_image_new_from_pixbuf (dest_pixbuf); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3722 } |
79340
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3723 else |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3724 { |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3725 fprintf (stderr, "internal error: GTK_IMAGE_PIXBUF failed\n"); |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3726 abort (); |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3727 } |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3728 } |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3729 else if (store_type == GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME) |
79340
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3730 { |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3731 const gchar *icon_name; |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3732 GtkIconSize icon_size; |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3733 |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3734 gtk_image_get_icon_name (wimage, &icon_name, &icon_size); |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3735 wmenuimage = gtk_image_new_from_icon_name (icon_name, |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3736 GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU); |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3737 } |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3738 else |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3739 { |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3740 fprintf (stderr, "internal error: store_type is %d\n", store_type); |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3741 abort (); |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3742 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3743 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3744 if (wmenuimage) |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3745 gtk_image_menu_item_set_image (GTK_IMAGE_MENU_ITEM (wmenuitem), wmenuimage); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3746 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3747 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenuitem), |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3748 "activate", |
103022
15bf0d8a6099
Make Emacs compile when Gtk+ and -DGTK_DISABLE_DEPRECATED is used.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102705
diff
changeset
|
3749 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_proxy_callback), |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3750 user_data); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3751 |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3752 |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3753 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wmenuitem), XG_TOOL_BAR_PROXY_BUTTON, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3754 (gpointer) wbutton); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3755 gtk_tool_item_set_proxy_menu_item (toolitem, "Emacs toolbar item", wmenuitem); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3756 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (wmenuitem, |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3757 gtk_widget_get_sensitive (GTK_WIDGET (wbutton))); |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3758 |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3759 /* Use enter/leave notify to show help. We use the events |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3760 rather than the GtkButton specific signals "enter" and |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3761 "leave", so we can have only one callback. The event |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3762 will tell us what kind of event it is. */ |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3763 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenuitem), |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3764 "enter-notify-event", |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3765 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback), |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3766 user_data); |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3767 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenuitem), |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3768 "leave-notify-event", |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3769 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback), |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3770 user_data); |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3771 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3772 return TRUE; |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3773 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3774 |
49323 | 3775 /* This callback is called when a tool bar is detached. We must set |
3776 the height of the tool bar to zero when this happens so frame sizes | |
3777 are correctly calculated. | |
3778 WBOX is the handle box widget that enables detach/attach of the tool bar. | |
3779 W is the tool bar widget. | |
3780 CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the frame the tool bar belongs to. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3781 |
49323 | 3782 static void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3783 xg_tool_bar_detach_callback (GtkHandleBox *wbox, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3784 GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3785 gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 3786 { |
3787 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) client_data; | |
68879
3249a3dd3284
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback): Set show-arrow to the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68874
diff
changeset
|
3788 |
3249a3dd3284
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback): Set show-arrow to the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68874
diff
changeset
|
3789 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (w), "show-arrow", !x_gtk_whole_detached_tool_bar, |
3249a3dd3284
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback): Set show-arrow to the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68874
diff
changeset
|
3790 NULL); |
49323 | 3791 |
3792 if (f) | |
3793 { | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3794 GtkRequisition req, req2; |
59420
eb72706060ad
* xterm.h (struct x_output): New member, toolbar_detached.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59411
diff
changeset
|
3795 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->toolbar_detached = 1; |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3796 gtk_widget_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (wbox), &req); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3797 gtk_widget_size_request (w, &req2); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3798 req.width -= req2.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3799 req.height -= req2.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3800 if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3801 FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3802 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3803 FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3804 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3805 FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3806 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3807 FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3808 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
49323 | 3809 } |
3810 } | |
3811 | |
3812 /* This callback is called when a tool bar is reattached. We must set | |
3813 the height of the tool bar when this happens so frame sizes | |
3814 are correctly calculated. | |
3815 WBOX is the handle box widget that enables detach/attach of the tool bar. | |
3816 W is the tool bar widget. | |
3817 CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the frame the tool bar belongs to. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3818 |
49323 | 3819 static void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3820 xg_tool_bar_attach_callback (GtkHandleBox *wbox, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3821 GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3822 gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 3823 { |
3824 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) client_data; | |
68879
3249a3dd3284
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback): Set show-arrow to the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68874
diff
changeset
|
3825 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (w), "show-arrow", TRUE, NULL); |
49323 | 3826 |
3827 if (f) | |
3828 { | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3829 GtkRequisition req, req2; |
59420
eb72706060ad
* xterm.h (struct x_output): New member, toolbar_detached.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59411
diff
changeset
|
3830 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->toolbar_detached = 0; |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3831 gtk_widget_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (wbox), &req); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3832 gtk_widget_size_request (w, &req2); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3833 req.width += req2.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3834 req.height += req2.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3835 if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3836 FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3837 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3838 FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3839 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3840 FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3841 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3842 FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3843 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
49323 | 3844 } |
3845 } | |
3846 | |
3847 /* This callback is called when the mouse enters or leaves a tool bar item. | |
3848 It is used for displaying and hiding the help text. | |
3849 W is the tool bar item, a button. | |
3850 EVENT is either an enter event or leave event. | |
3851 CLIENT_DATA is an integer that is the index of the button in the | |
3852 tool bar. 0 is the first button. | |
3853 | |
3854 Returns FALSE to tell GTK to keep processing this event. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3855 |
49323 | 3856 static gboolean |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3857 xg_tool_bar_help_callback (GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3858 GdkEventCrossing *event, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3859 gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 3860 { |
59411
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3861 /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3862 int idx = (int) (EMACS_INT) client_data; |
49323 | 3863 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), XG_FRAME_DATA); |
3864 Lisp_Object help, frame; | |
3865 | |
3866 if (! f || ! f->n_tool_bar_items || NILP (f->tool_bar_items)) | |
50108
a9ff586d3d09
(xg_tool_bar_help_callback): Add missing return value.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
50106
diff
changeset
|
3867 return FALSE; |
49323 | 3868 |
3869 if (event->type == GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY) | |
3870 { | |
3871 idx *= TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS; | |
3872 help = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_HELP); | |
3873 | |
3874 if (NILP (help)) | |
3875 help = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_CAPTION); | |
3876 } | |
3877 else | |
3878 help = Qnil; | |
3879 | |
3880 XSETFRAME (frame, f); | |
3881 kbd_buffer_store_help_event (frame, help); | |
3882 | |
3883 return FALSE; | |
3884 } | |
3885 | |
3886 | |
49826
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3887 /* This callback is called when a tool bar item shall be redrawn. |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3888 It modifies the expose event so that the GtkImage widget redraws the |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3889 whole image. This to overcome a bug that makes GtkImage draw the image |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3890 in the wrong place when it tries to redraw just a part of the image. |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3891 W is the GtkImage to be redrawn. |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3892 EVENT is the expose event for W. |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3893 CLIENT_DATA is unused. |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3894 |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3895 Returns FALSE to tell GTK to keep processing this event. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3896 |
49826
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3897 static gboolean |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3898 xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback (GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3899 GdkEventExpose *event, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3900 gpointer client_data) |
49826
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3901 { |
50333
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3902 gint width, height; |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3903 |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3904 gdk_drawable_get_size (event->window, &width, &height); |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3905 |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3906 event->area.x -= width > event->area.width ? width-event->area.width : 0; |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3907 event->area.y -= height > event->area.height ? height-event->area.height : 0; |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3908 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3909 event->area.x = max (0, event->area.x); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3910 event->area.y = max (0, event->area.y); |
60185
391f44959566
(xg_create_frame_widgets): UNBLOCK_INPUT on error.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59913
diff
changeset
|
3911 |
50333
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3912 event->area.width = max (width, event->area.width); |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3913 event->area.height = max (height, event->area.height); |
60185
391f44959566
(xg_create_frame_widgets): UNBLOCK_INPUT on error.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59913
diff
changeset
|
3914 |
49826
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3915 return FALSE; |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3916 } |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3917 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3918 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_ORIENTABLE_SET_ORIENTATION |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3919 #define toolbar_set_orientation(w, o) \ |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3920 gtk_orientable_set_orientation (GTK_ORIENTABLE (w), o) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3921 #else |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3922 #define toolbar_set_orientation(w, o) \ |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3923 gtk_toolbar_set_orientation (GTK_TOOLBAR (w), o) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3924 #endif |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3925 |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3926 /* Attach a tool bar to frame F. */ |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3927 |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3928 static void |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3929 xg_pack_tool_bar (FRAME_PTR f, Lisp_Object pos) |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3930 { |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3931 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3932 int into_hbox = EQ (pos, Qleft) || EQ (pos, Qright); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3933 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3934 toolbar_set_orientation (x->toolbar_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3935 into_hbox |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3936 ? GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3937 : GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3938 if (!x->handlebox_widget) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3939 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3940 x->handlebox_widget = gtk_handle_box_new (); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3941 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (x->handlebox_widget), "child-detached", |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3942 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback), f); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3943 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (x->handlebox_widget), "child-attached", |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3944 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_attach_callback), f); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3945 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (x->handlebox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3946 x->toolbar_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3947 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3948 |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3949 if (into_hbox) |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3950 { |
110389
4fd09e92be41
Put handle on top for vertical toolbar, Bug#7051.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109826
diff
changeset
|
3951 gtk_handle_box_set_handle_position (GTK_HANDLE_BOX (x->handlebox_widget), |
4fd09e92be41
Put handle on top for vertical toolbar, Bug#7051.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109826
diff
changeset
|
3952 GTK_POS_TOP); |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3953 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (x->hbox_widget), x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3954 FALSE, FALSE, 0); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3955 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3956 if (EQ (pos, Qleft)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3957 gtk_box_reorder_child (GTK_BOX (x->hbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3958 x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3959 0); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3960 x->toolbar_in_hbox = 1; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3961 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3962 else |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3963 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3964 int vbox_pos = x->menubar_widget ? 1 : 0; |
110389
4fd09e92be41
Put handle on top for vertical toolbar, Bug#7051.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109826
diff
changeset
|
3965 gtk_handle_box_set_handle_position (GTK_HANDLE_BOX (x->handlebox_widget), |
4fd09e92be41
Put handle on top for vertical toolbar, Bug#7051.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109826
diff
changeset
|
3966 GTK_POS_LEFT); |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3967 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (x->vbox_widget), x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3968 FALSE, FALSE, 0); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3969 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3970 if (EQ (pos, Qtop)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3971 gtk_box_reorder_child (GTK_BOX (x->vbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3972 x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3973 vbox_pos); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3974 x->toolbar_in_hbox = 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3975 } |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3976 } |
50063 | 3977 |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3978 /* Create a tool bar for frame F. */ |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3979 |
49323 | 3980 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3981 xg_create_tool_bar (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 3982 { |
3983 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; | |
3984 | |
3985 x->toolbar_widget = gtk_toolbar_new (); | |
59420
eb72706060ad
* xterm.h (struct x_output): New member, toolbar_detached.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59411
diff
changeset
|
3986 x->toolbar_detached = 0; |
eb72706060ad
* xterm.h (struct x_output): New member, toolbar_detached.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59411
diff
changeset
|
3987 |
49826
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3988 gtk_widget_set_name (x->toolbar_widget, "emacs-toolbar"); |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3989 |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3990 gtk_toolbar_set_style (GTK_TOOLBAR (x->toolbar_widget), GTK_TOOLBAR_ICONS); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
3991 toolbar_set_orientation (x->toolbar_widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL); |
49323 | 3992 } |
3993 | |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3994 |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3995 #define PROP(IDX) AREF (f->tool_bar_items, i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS + (IDX)) |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3996 |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3997 /* Find the right-to-left image named by RTL in the tool bar images for F. |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3998 Returns IMAGE if RTL is not found. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3999 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4000 static Lisp_Object |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4001 find_rtl_image (FRAME_PTR f, Lisp_Object image, Lisp_Object rtl) |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4002 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4003 int i; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4004 Lisp_Object file, rtl_name; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4005 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4006 GCPRO2 (file, rtl_name); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4007 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4008 rtl_name = Ffile_name_nondirectory (rtl); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4009 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4010 for (i = 0; i < f->n_tool_bar_items; ++i) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4011 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4012 Lisp_Object rtl_image = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_IMAGES); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
4013 if (!NILP (file = file_for_image (rtl_image))) |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4014 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4015 file = call1 (intern ("file-name-sans-extension"), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4016 Ffile_name_nondirectory (file)); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4017 if (EQ (Fequal (file, rtl_name), Qt)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4018 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4019 image = rtl_image; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4020 break; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4021 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4022 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4023 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4024 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4025 return image; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4026 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4027 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4028 static GtkToolItem * |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4029 xg_make_tool_item (FRAME_PTR f, |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4030 GtkWidget *wimage, |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4031 GtkWidget **wbutton, |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
4032 const char *label, |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4033 int i, int horiz, int text_image) |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4034 { |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4035 GtkToolItem *ti = gtk_tool_item_new (); |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4036 GtkWidget *vb = horiz ? gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0) : gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4037 GtkWidget *wb = gtk_button_new (); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4038 GtkWidget *weventbox = gtk_event_box_new (); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4039 |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4040 if (wimage && !text_image) |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4041 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vb), wimage, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4042 if (label) |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4043 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vb), gtk_label_new (label), TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4044 if (wimage && text_image) |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4045 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vb), wimage, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4046 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4047 gtk_button_set_focus_on_click (GTK_BUTTON (wb), FALSE); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4048 gtk_button_set_relief (GTK_BUTTON (wb), GTK_RELIEF_NONE); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4049 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (wb), vb); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4050 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (weventbox), wb); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4051 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (ti), weventbox); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4052 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4053 if (wimage) |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4054 { |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4055 /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4056 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (ti), "create-menu-proxy", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4057 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4058 (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) i); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4059 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4060 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wb), "clicked", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4061 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_callback), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4062 (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) i); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4063 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4064 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (weventbox), XG_FRAME_DATA, (gpointer)f); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4065 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4066 /* Catch expose events to overcome an annoying redraw bug, see |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4067 comment for xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback. */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4068 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (ti), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4069 "expose-event", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4070 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4071 0); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4072 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4073 gtk_tool_item_set_homogeneous (ti, FALSE); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4074 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4075 /* Callback to save modifyer mask (Shift/Control, etc). GTK makes |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4076 no distinction based on modifiers in the activate callback, |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4077 so we have to do it ourselves. */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4078 g_signal_connect (wb, "button-release-event", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4079 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_button_cb), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4080 NULL); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4081 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4082 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wb), XG_FRAME_DATA, (gpointer)f); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
4083 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4084 /* Use enter/leave notify to show help. We use the events |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4085 rather than the GtkButton specific signals "enter" and |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4086 "leave", so we can have only one callback. The event |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4087 will tell us what kind of event it is. */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4088 /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4089 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (weventbox), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4090 "enter-notify-event", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4091 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_help_callback), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4092 (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) i); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4093 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (weventbox), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4094 "leave-notify-event", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4095 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_help_callback), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4096 (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) i); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4097 } |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
4098 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4099 if (wbutton) *wbutton = wb; |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4100 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4101 return ti; |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4102 } |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4103 |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4104 static int |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4105 xg_tool_item_stale_p (GtkWidget *wbutton, const char *stock_name, |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4106 const char *icon_name, const struct image *img, |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4107 const char *label, int horiz) |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4108 { |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4109 gpointer old; |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4110 GtkWidget *wimage; |
111991
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4111 GtkWidget *vb = XG_BIN_CHILD (wbutton); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4112 GtkWidget *wlbl = xg_get_tool_bar_widgets (vb, &wimage); |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4113 |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4114 /* Check if the tool icon matches. */ |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4115 if (stock_name) |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4116 { |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4117 old = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4118 XG_TOOL_BAR_STOCK_NAME); |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4119 if (!old || strcmp (old, stock_name)) |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4120 return 1; |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4121 } |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4122 else if (icon_name) |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4123 { |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4124 old = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4125 XG_TOOL_BAR_ICON_NAME); |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4126 if (!old || strcmp (old, icon_name)) |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4127 return 1; |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4128 } |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4129 else |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4130 { |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4131 Pixmap old_img |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4132 = (Pixmap) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4133 XG_TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DATA); |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4134 if (old_img != img->pixmap) |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4135 return 1; |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4136 } |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4137 |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4138 /* Check button configuration and label. */ |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4139 if ((horiz ? GTK_IS_VBOX (vb) : GTK_IS_HBOX (vb)) |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4140 || (label ? (wlbl == NULL) : (wlbl != NULL))) |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4141 return 1; |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4142 |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4143 /* Ensure label is correct. */ |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4144 if (label) |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4145 gtk_label_set_text (GTK_LABEL (wlbl), label); |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4146 return 0; |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4147 } |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4148 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4149 static int |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4150 xg_update_tool_bar_sizes (FRAME_PTR f) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4151 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4152 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4153 GtkRequisition req; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4154 int nl = 0, nr = 0, nt = 0, nb = 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4155 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4156 gtk_widget_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (x->handlebox_widget), &req); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4157 if (x->toolbar_in_hbox) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4158 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4159 int pos; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4160 gtk_container_child_get (GTK_CONTAINER (x->hbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4161 x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4162 "position", &pos, NULL); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4163 if (pos == 0) nl = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4164 else nr = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4165 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4166 else |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4167 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4168 int pos; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4169 gtk_container_child_get (GTK_CONTAINER (x->vbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4170 x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4171 "position", &pos, NULL); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4172 if (pos == 0 || (pos == 1 && x->menubar_widget)) nt = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4173 else nb = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4174 } |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
4175 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4176 if (nl != FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4177 || nr != FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4178 || nt != FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4179 || nb != FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4180 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4181 FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) = FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4182 = FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) = FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) = 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4183 FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) = nl; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4184 FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) = nr; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4185 FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) = nt; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4186 FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) = nb; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4187 return 1; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4188 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4189 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4190 return 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4191 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4192 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4193 |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4194 /* Update the tool bar for frame F. Add new buttons and remove old. */ |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4195 |
49323 | 4196 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4197 update_frame_tool_bar (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 4198 { |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4199 int i, j; |
49323 | 4200 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
75576
e852dba095f9
(update_frame_tool_bar): Initialize h/vmargin to 0.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75417
diff
changeset
|
4201 int hmargin = 0, vmargin = 0; |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4202 GtkToolbar *wtoolbar; |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4203 GtkToolItem *ti; |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4204 GtkTextDirection dir; |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
4205 int pack_tool_bar = x->handlebox_widget == NULL; |
49323 | 4206 |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4207 Lisp_Object style; |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4208 int text_image, horiz; |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4209 |
49323 | 4210 if (! FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f)) |
4211 return; | |
4212 | |
4213 BLOCK_INPUT; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
4214 |
59084
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4215 if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4216 && XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) > 0) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4217 { |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4218 hmargin = XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4219 vmargin = XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4220 } |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4221 else if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4222 { |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4223 if (INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4224 && XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) > 0) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4225 hmargin = XFASTINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4226 |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4227 if (INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4228 && XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) > 0) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4229 vmargin = XFASTINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4230 } |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4231 |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4232 /* The natural size (i.e. when GTK uses 0 as margin) looks best, |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4233 so take DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN to mean "default for GTK", |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4234 i.e. zero. This means that margins less than |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4235 DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN has no effect. */ |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4236 hmargin = max (0, hmargin - DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4237 vmargin = max (0, vmargin - DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN); |
60185
391f44959566
(xg_create_frame_widgets): UNBLOCK_INPUT on error.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59913
diff
changeset
|
4238 |
49323 | 4239 if (! x->toolbar_widget) |
4240 xg_create_tool_bar (f); | |
4241 | |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4242 wtoolbar = GTK_TOOLBAR (x->toolbar_widget); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4243 dir = gtk_widget_get_direction (GTK_WIDGET (wtoolbar)); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
4244 |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4245 style = Ftool_bar_get_system_style (); |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4246 text_image = EQ (style, Qtext_image_horiz); |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4247 horiz = EQ (style, Qboth_horiz) || text_image; |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4248 |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4249 for (i = j = 0; i < f->n_tool_bar_items; ++i) |
49323 | 4250 { |
4251 int enabled_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P)); | |
4252 int selected_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_SELECTED_P)); | |
4253 int idx; | |
4254 int img_id; | |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4255 int icon_size = 0; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4256 struct image *img = NULL; |
49323 | 4257 Lisp_Object image; |
100100
f5d2a2e44839
(update_frame_tool_bar): Initialize variable.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98555
diff
changeset
|
4258 Lisp_Object stock = Qnil; |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4259 GtkStockItem stock_item; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4260 char *stock_name = NULL; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4261 char *icon_name = NULL; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4262 Lisp_Object rtl; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4263 GtkWidget *wbutton = NULL; |
79460
1d493051aed3
(update_frame_tool_bar): Don't call x-gtk-map-stock if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
79340
diff
changeset
|
4264 Lisp_Object specified_file; |
111650
8fd0d7bcdf7d
Add keyword :vert-only for tool bar items with labels not shown horizontally.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
111186
diff
changeset
|
4265 int vert_only = ! NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_VERT_ONLY)); |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4266 const char *label |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4267 = (EQ (style, Qimage) || (vert_only && horiz)) ? NULL |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4268 : STRINGP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_LABEL)) |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4269 ? SSDATA (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_LABEL)) |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4270 : ""; |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4271 |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4272 ti = gtk_toolbar_get_nth_item (GTK_TOOLBAR (wtoolbar), j); |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4273 |
111991
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4274 /* If this is a separator, use a gtk separator item. */ |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4275 if (EQ (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_TYPE), Qt)) |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4276 { |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4277 if (ti == NULL || !GTK_IS_SEPARATOR_TOOL_ITEM (ti)) |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4278 { |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4279 if (ti) |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4280 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (wtoolbar), |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4281 GTK_WIDGET (ti)); |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4282 ti = gtk_separator_tool_item_new (); |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4283 gtk_toolbar_insert (GTK_TOOLBAR (wtoolbar), ti, j); |
111991
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4284 } |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4285 j++; |
111991
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4286 continue; |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4287 } |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4288 |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4289 /* Otherwise, the tool-bar item is an ordinary button. */ |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4290 |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4291 if (ti && GTK_IS_SEPARATOR_TOOL_ITEM (ti)) |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4292 { |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4293 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (wtoolbar), GTK_WIDGET (ti)); |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4294 ti = NULL; |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4295 } |
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4296 |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4297 if (ti) wbutton = XG_BIN_CHILD (XG_BIN_CHILD (ti)); |
49323 | 4298 |
4299 /* Ignore invalid image specifications. */ | |
111991
968255ee954a
Support for menu separators in the GTK tool-bar.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111781
diff
changeset
|
4300 image = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_IMAGES); |
49323 | 4301 if (!valid_image_p (image)) |
4302 { | |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4303 if (ti) |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4304 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (wtoolbar), |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4305 GTK_WIDGET (ti)); |
49323 | 4306 continue; |
4307 } | |
4308 | |
79460
1d493051aed3
(update_frame_tool_bar): Don't call x-gtk-map-stock if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
79340
diff
changeset
|
4309 specified_file = file_for_image (image); |
103916
9653887b5cd0
* xterm.c (Qx_gtk_map_stock): New var.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103690
diff
changeset
|
4310 if (!NILP (specified_file) && !NILP (Ffboundp (Qx_gtk_map_stock))) |
9653887b5cd0
* xterm.c (Qx_gtk_map_stock): New var.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103690
diff
changeset
|
4311 stock = call1 (Qx_gtk_map_stock, specified_file); |
9653887b5cd0
* xterm.c (Qx_gtk_map_stock): New var.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103690
diff
changeset
|
4312 |
9653887b5cd0
* xterm.c (Qx_gtk_map_stock): New var.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103690
diff
changeset
|
4313 if (STRINGP (stock)) |
49468
f2be5cd8262f
gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Call prepare_image_for_display
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49434
diff
changeset
|
4314 { |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4315 stock_name = SSDATA (stock); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4316 if (stock_name[0] == 'n' && stock_name[1] == ':') |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4317 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4318 GdkScreen *screen = gtk_widget_get_screen (GTK_WIDGET (wtoolbar)); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4319 GtkIconTheme *icon_theme = gtk_icon_theme_get_for_screen (screen); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4320 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4321 icon_name = stock_name + 2; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4322 stock_name = NULL; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4323 stock = Qnil; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4324 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4325 if (! gtk_icon_theme_has_icon (icon_theme, icon_name)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4326 icon_name = NULL; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4327 else |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4328 icon_size = gtk_toolbar_get_icon_size (wtoolbar); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4329 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4330 else if (gtk_stock_lookup (SSDATA (stock), &stock_item)) |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4331 icon_size = gtk_toolbar_get_icon_size (wtoolbar); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
4332 else |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4333 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4334 stock = Qnil; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4335 stock_name = NULL; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4336 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4337 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4338 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4339 if (stock_name == NULL && icon_name == NULL) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4340 { |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4341 /* No stock image, or stock item not known. Try regular |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4342 image. If image is a vector, choose it according to the |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4343 button state. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4344 if (dir == GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4345 && !NILP (rtl = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_RTL_IMAGE)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4346 && STRINGP (rtl)) |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4347 image = find_rtl_image (f, image, rtl); |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4348 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4349 if (VECTORP (image)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4350 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4351 if (enabled_p) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4352 idx = (selected_p |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4353 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_SELECTED |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4354 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_DESELECTED); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4355 else |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4356 idx = (selected_p |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4357 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_SELECTED |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4358 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_DESELECTED); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4359 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4360 xassert (ASIZE (image) >= idx); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4361 image = AREF (image, idx); |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4362 } |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4363 else |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4364 idx = -1; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4365 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4366 img_id = lookup_image (f, image); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4367 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, img_id); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4368 prepare_image_for_display (f, img); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
4369 |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4370 if (img->load_failed_p || img->pixmap == None) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4371 { |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4372 if (ti) |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4373 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (wtoolbar), |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4374 GTK_WIDGET (ti)); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4375 continue; |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4376 } |
49468
f2be5cd8262f
gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Call prepare_image_for_display
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49434
diff
changeset
|
4377 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
4378 |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4379 /* If there is an existing widget, check if it's stale; if so, |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4380 remove it and make a new tool item from scratch. */ |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4381 if (ti && xg_tool_item_stale_p (wbutton, stock_name, icon_name, |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4382 img, label, horiz)) |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4383 { |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4384 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (wtoolbar), |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4385 GTK_WIDGET (ti)); |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4386 ti = NULL; |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4387 } |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4388 |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4389 if (ti == NULL) |
49323 | 4390 { |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4391 GtkWidget *w; |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4392 |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4393 /* Save the image so we can see if an update is needed the |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4394 next time we call xg_tool_item_match_p. */ |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4395 if (EQ (style, Qtext)) |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4396 w = NULL; |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4397 else if (stock_name) |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4398 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4399 w = gtk_image_new_from_stock (stock_name, icon_size); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4400 g_object_set_data_full (G_OBJECT (w), XG_TOOL_BAR_STOCK_NAME, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4401 (gpointer) xstrdup (stock_name), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4402 (GDestroyNotify) xfree); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4403 } |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
4404 else if (icon_name) |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4405 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4406 w = gtk_image_new_from_icon_name (icon_name, icon_size); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4407 g_object_set_data_full (G_OBJECT (w), XG_TOOL_BAR_ICON_NAME, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4408 (gpointer) xstrdup (icon_name), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4409 (GDestroyNotify) xfree); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4410 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4411 else |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4412 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4413 w = xg_get_image_for_pixmap (f, img, x->widget, NULL); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4414 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (w), XG_TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DATA, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4415 (gpointer)img->pixmap); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4416 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4417 |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4418 if (w) gtk_misc_set_padding (GTK_MISC (w), hmargin, vmargin); |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4419 ti = xg_make_tool_item (f, w, &wbutton, label, i, horiz, text_image); |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4420 gtk_toolbar_insert (GTK_TOOLBAR (wtoolbar), ti, j); |
49323 | 4421 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
4422 |
49323 | 4423 #undef PROP |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4424 |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4425 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (wbutton, enabled_p); |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4426 j++; |
49323 | 4427 } |
4428 | |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4429 /* Remove buttons not longer needed. */ |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4430 do |
49323 | 4431 { |
112168
744d9787c683
Minor fix to GTK tool-bar button refresh code.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
112043
diff
changeset
|
4432 ti = gtk_toolbar_get_nth_item (GTK_TOOLBAR (wtoolbar), j); |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4433 if (ti) |
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4434 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (wtoolbar), GTK_WIDGET (ti)); |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4435 } while (ti != NULL); |
49323 | 4436 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4437 if (f->n_tool_bar_items != 0) |
49323 | 4438 { |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4439 if (pack_tool_bar) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4440 xg_pack_tool_bar (f, f->tool_bar_position); |
112043
dffe14ef6b65
Reduce GTK tool-bar switching delay by avoiding selective show/hide of widgets.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111991
diff
changeset
|
4441 gtk_widget_show_all (GTK_WIDGET (x->handlebox_widget)); |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4442 if (xg_update_tool_bar_sizes (f)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4443 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
49323 | 4444 } |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4445 |
49323 | 4446 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
4447 } | |
4448 | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4449 /* Deallocate all resources for the tool bar on frame F. |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4450 Remove the tool bar. */ |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4451 |
49323 | 4452 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4453 free_frame_tool_bar (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 4454 { |
4455 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; | |
4456 | |
4457 if (x->toolbar_widget) | |
4458 { | |
93030
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4459 int is_packed = x->handlebox_widget != 0; |
49323 | 4460 BLOCK_INPUT; |
93030
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4461 /* We may have created the toolbar_widget in xg_create_tool_bar, but |
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4462 not the x->handlebox_widget which is created in xg_pack_tool_bar. */ |
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4463 if (is_packed) |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4464 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4465 if (x->toolbar_in_hbox) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4466 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (x->hbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4467 x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4468 else |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4469 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (x->vbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4470 x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4471 } |
93030
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4472 else |
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4473 gtk_widget_destroy (x->toolbar_widget); |
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4474 |
49323 | 4475 x->toolbar_widget = 0; |
4476 x->handlebox_widget = 0; | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4477 FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) = FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) = 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4478 FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) = FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) = 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4479 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4480 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
4481 |
49323 | 4482 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
4483 } | |
4484 } | |
4485 | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4486 int |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4487 xg_change_toolbar_position (FRAME_PTR f, Lisp_Object pos) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4488 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4489 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4490 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4491 if (! x->toolbar_widget || ! x->handlebox_widget) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4492 return 1; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4493 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4494 BLOCK_INPUT; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4495 g_object_ref (x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4496 if (x->toolbar_in_hbox) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4497 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (x->hbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4498 x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4499 else |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4500 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (x->vbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4501 x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4502 xg_pack_tool_bar (f, pos); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4503 g_object_unref (x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4504 if (xg_update_tool_bar_sizes (f)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4505 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4506 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4507 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4508 return 1; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4509 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4510 |
49323 | 4511 |
4512 | |
4513 /*********************************************************************** | |
4514 Initializing | |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4515 ***********************************************************************/ |
49323 | 4516 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4517 xg_initialize (void) |
49323 | 4518 { |
59102
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4519 GtkBindingSet *binding_set; |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4520 |
75417
c21d47d727f3
(xg_initialize): Call XftInit if HAVE_XFT.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
4521 #if HAVE_XFT |
c21d47d727f3
(xg_initialize): Call XftInit if HAVE_XFT.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
4522 /* Work around a bug with corrupted data if libXft gets unloaded. This way |
c21d47d727f3
(xg_initialize): Call XftInit if HAVE_XFT.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
4523 we keep it permanently linked in. */ |
c21d47d727f3
(xg_initialize): Call XftInit if HAVE_XFT.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
4524 XftInit (0); |
c21d47d727f3
(xg_initialize): Call XftInit if HAVE_XFT.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
4525 #endif |
84621 | 4526 |
4527 gdpy_def = NULL; | |
49323 | 4528 xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar = 0; |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
4529 xg_detached_menus = 0; |
49323 | 4530 xg_menu_cb_list.prev = xg_menu_cb_list.next = |
4531 xg_menu_item_cb_list.prev = xg_menu_item_cb_list.next = 0; | |
4532 | |
49419
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4533 id_to_widget.max_size = id_to_widget.used = 0; |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4534 id_to_widget.widgets = 0; |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4535 |
49323 | 4536 /* Remove F10 as a menu accelerator, it does not mix well with Emacs key |
4537 bindings. It doesn't seem to be any way to remove properties, | |
4538 so we set it to VoidSymbol which in X means "no key". */ | |
4539 gtk_settings_set_string_property (gtk_settings_get_default (), | |
4540 "gtk-menu-bar-accel", | |
4541 "VoidSymbol", | |
4542 EMACS_CLASS); | |
49419
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4543 |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4544 /* Make GTK text input widgets use Emacs style keybindings. This is |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4545 Emacs after all. */ |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4546 gtk_settings_set_string_property (gtk_settings_get_default (), |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4547 "gtk-key-theme-name", |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4548 "Emacs", |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4549 EMACS_CLASS); |
59102
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4550 |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4551 /* Make dialogs close on C-g. Since file dialog inherits from |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4552 dialog, this works for them also. */ |
103022
15bf0d8a6099
Make Emacs compile when Gtk+ and -DGTK_DISABLE_DEPRECATED is used.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102705
diff
changeset
|
4553 binding_set = gtk_binding_set_by_class (g_type_class_ref (GTK_TYPE_DIALOG)); |
59102
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4554 gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_g, GDK_CONTROL_MASK, |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4555 "close", 0); |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4556 |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4557 /* Make menus close on C-g. */ |
103022
15bf0d8a6099
Make Emacs compile when Gtk+ and -DGTK_DISABLE_DEPRECATED is used.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102705
diff
changeset
|
4558 binding_set = gtk_binding_set_by_class (g_type_class_ref |
15bf0d8a6099
Make Emacs compile when Gtk+ and -DGTK_DISABLE_DEPRECATED is used.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102705
diff
changeset
|
4559 (GTK_TYPE_MENU_SHELL)); |
59102
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4560 gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_g, GDK_CONTROL_MASK, |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4561 "cancel", 0); |
49323 | 4562 } |
4563 | |
4564 #endif /* USE_GTK */ |